2003-03-10 Andrew Cagney <cagney@redhat.com>
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
3 @c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003
4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5 @c
6 @c %**start of header
7 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9 @setfilename gdb.info
10 @c
11 @include gdb-cfg.texi
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @syncodeindex ky cp
24
25 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
26 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
27 @syncodeindex vr cp
28 @syncodeindex fn cp
29
30 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
31 @set EDITION Ninth
32
33 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
34 @set DATE June 2002
35
36 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
37 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
38
39 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
40
41 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
42 @c manuals to an info tree.
43 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
44 @direntry
45 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
46 @end direntry
47
48 @ifinfo
49 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
50
51
52 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
53 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
54 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
55
56 Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
57 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
58
59 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
60 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
61 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
62 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
63 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
64 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
65
66 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
67 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
68 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
69 development.''
70 @end ifinfo
71
72 @titlepage
73 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
74 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
75 @sp 1
76 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
77 @subtitle @value{DATE}
78 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
79 @page
80 @tex
81 {\parskip=0pt
82 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
83 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
84 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
85 }
86 @end tex
87
88 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
89 Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
90 1996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
91 @sp 2
92 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
93 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
94 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
95 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
96
97 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
98 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
99 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
100 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
101 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
102 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
103
104 (a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
105 freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
106 published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
107 development.''
108 @end titlepage
109 @page
110
111 @ifnottex
112 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
113
114 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
115
116 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
117
118 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
119 @value{GDBVN}.
120
121 Copyright (C) 1988-2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
122
123 @menu
124 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
125 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
126
127 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
128 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
129 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
130 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
131 * Stack:: Examining the stack
132 * Source:: Examining source files
133 * Data:: Examining data
134 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
135 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
136 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
137
138 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
139
140 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
141 * Altering:: Altering execution
142 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
143 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
144 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
145 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
146 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
147 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
148 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
149 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
150 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
151 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
152 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
153
154 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
155 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
156
157 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
158 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
159 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
160 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
161 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
162 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
163 how you can copy and share GDB
164 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
165 * Index:: Index
166 @end menu
167
168 @end ifnottex
169
170 @contents
171
172 @node Summary
173 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
174
175 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
176 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
177 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
178
179 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
180 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
181
182 @itemize @bullet
183 @item
184 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
185
186 @item
187 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
188
189 @item
190 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
191
192 @item
193 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
194 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
195 @end itemize
196
197 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
198 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
199 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
200
201 @cindex Modula-2
202 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
203 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
204
205 @cindex Pascal
206 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
207 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
208 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
209 syntax.
210
211 @cindex Fortran
212 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
213 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
214 underscore.
215
216 @menu
217 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
218 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
219 @end menu
220
221 @node Free Software
222 @unnumberedsec Free software
223
224 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
225 General Public License
226 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
227 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
228 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
229 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
230 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
231 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
232
233 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
234 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
235 from anyone else.
236
237 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
238
239 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
240 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
241 include with the free software. Many of our most important
242 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
243 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
244 when an important free software package does not come with a free
245 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
246 gaps today.
247
248 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
249 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
250 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
251 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
252 them from the free software world.
253
254 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
255 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
256 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
257 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
258 contract to make it non-free.
259
260 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
261 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
262 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
263 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
264 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
265 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
266 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
267
268 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
269 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
270 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
271 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
272
273 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
274 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
275 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
276 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
277 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
278 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
279 community.
280
281 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
282 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
283 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
284 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
285 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
286 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
287 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
288 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
289 of the manual.
290
291 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
292 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
293 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
294 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
295 manual to replace it.
296
297 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
298 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
299 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
300 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
301 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
302 the free software community.
303
304 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
305 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
306 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
307 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
308 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
309 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
310 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
311 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
312 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
313
314 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
315 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
316 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
317 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
318 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
319 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
320 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
321 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
322
323 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
324 published by other publishers, at
325 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
326
327 @node Contributors
328 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
329
330 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
331 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
332 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
333 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
334 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
335 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
336 blow-by-blow account.
337
338 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
339
340 @quotation
341 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
342 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
343 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
344 @end quotation
345
346 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
347 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
348 releases:
349 Andrew Cagney (releases 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
350 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
351 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
352 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
353 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
354 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
355 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
356 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
357 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
358
359 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
360 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
361
362 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
363 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
364 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
365 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
366 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
367
368 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
369 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
370 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
371
372 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
373 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
374
375 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
376
377 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
378 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
379 support.
380 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
381 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
382 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
383 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
384 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
385 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
386 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
387 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
388 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
389 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
390 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
391 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
392 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
393 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
394 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
395 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
396
397 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
398
399 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
400 libraries.
401
402 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
403 about several machine instruction sets.
404
405 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
406 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
407 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
408 and RDI targets, respectively.
409
410 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
411 command-line editing and command history.
412
413 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
414 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
415
416 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
417 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
418 symbols.
419
420 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
421 Super-H processors.
422
423 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
424
425 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
426
427 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
428
429 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
430
431 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
432
433 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
434 watchpoints.
435
436 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
437
438 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
439
440 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
441 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
442
443 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
444 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
445 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
446 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
447 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
448 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
449 information in this manual.
450
451 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
452 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
453
454 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
455 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
456 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
457 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
458 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
459 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
460 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
461 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
462 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
463 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
464 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
465 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
466 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
467 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
468 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
469
470 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
471 Hat.
472
473 @node Sample Session
474 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
475
476 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
477 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
478 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
479
480 @iftex
481 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
482 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
483 @end iftex
484
485 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
486 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
487
488 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
489 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
490 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
491 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
492 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
493 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
494 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
495 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
496 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
497
498 @smallexample
499 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
500 $ @b{./m4}
501 @b{define(foo,0000)}
502
503 @b{foo}
504 0000
505 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
506
507 @b{bar}
508 0000
509 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
510
511 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
512 @b{baz}
513 @b{C-d}
514 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
515 @end smallexample
516
517 @noindent
518 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
519
520 @smallexample
521 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
522 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
523 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
524 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
525 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
526 the conditions.
527 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
528 for details.
529
530 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
531 (@value{GDBP})
532 @end smallexample
533
534 @noindent
535 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
536 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
537 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
538 that examples fit in this manual.
539
540 @smallexample
541 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
542 @end smallexample
543
544 @noindent
545 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
546 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
547 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
548 @code{break} command.
549
550 @smallexample
551 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
552 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
553 @end smallexample
554
555 @noindent
556 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
557 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
558 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
559
560 @smallexample
561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
562 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
563 @b{define(foo,0000)}
564
565 @b{foo}
566 0000
567 @end smallexample
568
569 @noindent
570 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
571 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
572 context where it stops.
573
574 @smallexample
575 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
576
577 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
578 at builtin.c:879
579 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
580 @end smallexample
581
582 @noindent
583 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
584 the next line of the current function.
585
586 @smallexample
587 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
588 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
589 : nil,
590 @end smallexample
591
592 @noindent
593 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
594 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
595 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
596 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
597
598 @smallexample
599 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
600 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
601 at input.c:530
602 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
603 @end smallexample
604
605 @noindent
606 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
607 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
608 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
609 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
610 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
611 stack frame for each active subroutine.
612
613 @smallexample
614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
615 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
616 at input.c:530
617 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
618 at builtin.c:882
619 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
620 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
621 at macro.c:71
622 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
623 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
624 @end smallexample
625
626 @noindent
627 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
628 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
629 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
633 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
635 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
636 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
637 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
638 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
639 : xstrdup(rq);
640 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
641 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
642 @end smallexample
643
644 @noindent
645 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
646 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
647 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
648 (@code{print}) to see their values.
649
650 @smallexample
651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
652 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
653 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
654 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
655 @end smallexample
656
657 @noindent
658 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
659 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
660 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
661
662 @smallexample
663 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
664 533 xfree(rquote);
665 534
666 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
667 : xstrdup (lq);
668 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
669 : xstrdup (rq);
670 537
671 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
672 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
673 540 @}
674 541
675 542 void
676 @end smallexample
677
678 @noindent
679 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
680 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
681
682 @smallexample
683 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
684 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
685 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
686 540 @}
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
688 $3 = 9
689 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
690 $4 = 7
691 @end smallexample
692
693 @noindent
694 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
695 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
696 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
697 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
698 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
699 assignments.
700
701 @smallexample
702 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
703 $5 = 7
704 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
705 $6 = 9
706 @end smallexample
707
708 @noindent
709 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
710 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
711 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
712 example that caused trouble initially:
713
714 @smallexample
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
716 Continuing.
717
718 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
719
720 baz
721 0000
722 @end smallexample
723
724 @noindent
725 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
726 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
727 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
728
729 @smallexample
730 @b{C-d}
731 Program exited normally.
732 @end smallexample
733
734 @noindent
735 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
736 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
737 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
738
739 @smallexample
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
741 @end smallexample
742
743 @node Invocation
744 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
745
746 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
747 The essentials are:
748 @itemize @bullet
749 @item
750 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
751 @item
752 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
753 @end itemize
754
755 @menu
756 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
757 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
758 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
759 @end menu
760
761 @node Invoking GDB
762 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
763
764 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
765 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
766
767 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
768 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
769
770 The command-line options described here are designed
771 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
772 options may effectively be unavailable.
773
774 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
775 specifying an executable program:
776
777 @smallexample
778 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
779 @end smallexample
780
781 @noindent
782 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
783 specified:
784
785 @smallexample
786 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
787 @end smallexample
788
789 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
790 to debug a running process:
791
792 @smallexample
793 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
794 @end smallexample
795
796 @noindent
797 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
798 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
799
800 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
801 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
802 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
803 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
804 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
805
806 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
807 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
808 option processing.
809 @smallexample
810 gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
811 @end smallexample
812 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
813 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
814
815 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
816 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
817
818 @smallexample
819 @value{GDBP} -silent
820 @end smallexample
821
822 @noindent
823 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
824 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
825
826 @noindent
827 Type
828
829 @smallexample
830 @value{GDBP} -help
831 @end smallexample
832
833 @noindent
834 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
835 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
836
837 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
838 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
839 @samp{-x} option is used.
840
841
842 @menu
843 * File Options:: Choosing files
844 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
845 @end menu
846
847 @node File Options
848 @subsection Choosing files
849
850 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
851 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
852 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
853 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
854 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
855 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
856 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
857 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
858 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
859 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
860 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
861 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
862 prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
863
864 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
865 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
866 argument and ignore it.
867
868 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
869 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
870 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
871 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
872 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
873
874 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
875 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
876 @c it.
877
878 @table @code
879 @item -symbols @var{file}
880 @itemx -s @var{file}
881 @cindex @code{--symbols}
882 @cindex @code{-s}
883 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
884
885 @item -exec @var{file}
886 @itemx -e @var{file}
887 @cindex @code{--exec}
888 @cindex @code{-e}
889 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
890 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
891
892 @item -se @var{file}
893 @cindex @code{--se}
894 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
895 file.
896
897 @item -core @var{file}
898 @itemx -c @var{file}
899 @cindex @code{--core}
900 @cindex @code{-c}
901 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
902
903 @item -c @var{number}
904 @item -pid @var{number}
905 @itemx -p @var{number}
906 @cindex @code{--pid}
907 @cindex @code{-p}
908 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
909 If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
910 file named @var{number}.
911
912 @item -command @var{file}
913 @itemx -x @var{file}
914 @cindex @code{--command}
915 @cindex @code{-x}
916 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
917 Files,, Command files}.
918
919 @item -directory @var{directory}
920 @itemx -d @var{directory}
921 @cindex @code{--directory}
922 @cindex @code{-d}
923 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
924
925 @item -m
926 @itemx -mapped
927 @cindex @code{--mapped}
928 @cindex @code{-m}
929 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
930 supported on all systems.}@*
931 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
932 system call, you can use this option
933 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
934 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
935 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
936 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
937 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
938 the symbol table from the executable program.
939
940 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
941 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
942 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
943
944 @item -r
945 @itemx -readnow
946 @cindex @code{--readnow}
947 @cindex @code{-r}
948 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
949 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
950 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
951
952 @end table
953
954 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
955 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
956 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
957 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
958 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
959
960 @smallexample
961 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
962 @end smallexample
963
964 @node Mode Options
965 @subsection Choosing modes
966
967 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
968 batch mode or quiet mode.
969
970 @table @code
971 @item -nx
972 @itemx -n
973 @cindex @code{--nx}
974 @cindex @code{-n}
975 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
976 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
977 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
978 files}.
979
980 @item -quiet
981 @itemx -silent
982 @itemx -q
983 @cindex @code{--quiet}
984 @cindex @code{--silent}
985 @cindex @code{-q}
986 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
987 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
988
989 @item -batch
990 @cindex @code{--batch}
991 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
992 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
993 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
994 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
995 in the command files.
996
997 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
998 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
999 make this more useful, the message
1000
1001 @smallexample
1002 Program exited normally.
1003 @end smallexample
1004
1005 @noindent
1006 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1007 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1008 mode.
1009
1010 @item -nowindows
1011 @itemx -nw
1012 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1013 @cindex @code{-nw}
1014 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1015 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1016 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1017
1018 @item -windows
1019 @itemx -w
1020 @cindex @code{--windows}
1021 @cindex @code{-w}
1022 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1023 used if possible.
1024
1025 @item -cd @var{directory}
1026 @cindex @code{--cd}
1027 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1028 instead of the current directory.
1029
1030 @item -fullname
1031 @itemx -f
1032 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1033 @cindex @code{-f}
1034 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1035 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1036 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1037 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1038 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1039 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1040 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1041 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1042 frame.
1043
1044 @item -epoch
1045 @cindex @code{--epoch}
1046 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1047 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1048 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1049 separate window.
1050
1051 @item -annotate @var{level}
1052 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1053 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1054 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1055 (@pxref{Annotations}).
1056 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1057 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1058 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1059 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1060 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1061
1062 @item -async
1063 @cindex @code{--async}
1064 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1065 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1066 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1067 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1068 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1069 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1070 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1071 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1072 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
1073 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1074 yet.)
1075 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1076 @c should be removed.
1077
1078 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1079 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1080 @samp{-noasync} option.
1081
1082 @item -noasync
1083 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1084 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1085
1086 @item --args
1087 @cindex @code{--args}
1088 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1089 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1090 This option stops option processing.
1091
1092 @item -baud @var{bps}
1093 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1094 @cindex @code{--baud}
1095 @cindex @code{-b}
1096 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1097 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1098
1099 @item -tty @var{device}
1100 @itemx -t @var{device}
1101 @cindex @code{--tty}
1102 @cindex @code{-t}
1103 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1104 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1105
1106 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1107 @item -tui
1108 @cindex @code{--tui}
1109 Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1110 The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1111 showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1112 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1113 Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1114 (@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1115
1116 @c @item -xdb
1117 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1118 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1119 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1120 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1121 @c systems.
1122
1123 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1124 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1125 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1126 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1127 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1128 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1129
1130 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1131 @value{GDBN} to use the current @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface}
1132 (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The previous @sc{gdb/mi}
1133 interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3, can be selected with
1134 @samp{--interpreter=mi1}. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces
1135 are not supported.
1136
1137 @item -write
1138 @cindex @code{--write}
1139 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1140 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1141 (@pxref{Patching}).
1142
1143 @item -statistics
1144 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1145 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1146 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1147
1148 @item -version
1149 @cindex @code{--version}
1150 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1151 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1152
1153 @end table
1154
1155 @node Quitting GDB
1156 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1157 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1158 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1159
1160 @table @code
1161 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1162 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1163 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1164 @itemx q
1165 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1166 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1167 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1168 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1169 error code.
1170 @end table
1171
1172 @cindex interrupt
1173 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1174 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1175 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1176 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1177 until a time when it is safe.
1178
1179 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1180 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1181 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1182
1183 @node Shell Commands
1184 @section Shell commands
1185
1186 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1187 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1188 just use the @code{shell} command.
1189
1190 @table @code
1191 @kindex shell
1192 @cindex shell escape
1193 @item shell @var{command string}
1194 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1195 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1196 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1197 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1198 @end table
1199
1200 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1201 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1202 @value{GDBN}:
1203
1204 @table @code
1205 @kindex make
1206 @cindex calling make
1207 @item make @var{make-args}
1208 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1209 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1210 @end table
1211
1212 @node Commands
1213 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1214
1215 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1216 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1217 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1218 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1219 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1220
1221 @menu
1222 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1223 * Completion:: Command completion
1224 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1225 @end menu
1226
1227 @node Command Syntax
1228 @section Command syntax
1229
1230 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1231 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1232 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1233 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1234 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1235 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1236
1237 @cindex abbreviation
1238 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1239 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1240 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1241 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1242 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1243 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1244 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1245
1246 @cindex repeating commands
1247 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1248 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1249 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1250 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1251 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1252 repeat.
1253
1254 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1255 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1256 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1257
1258 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1259 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1260 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1261 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1262 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1263
1264 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1265 @cindex comment
1266 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1267 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1268 Files,,Command files}).
1269
1270 @cindex repeating command sequences
1271 @kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1272 The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1273 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1274 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1275 for editing.
1276
1277 @node Completion
1278 @section Command completion
1279
1280 @cindex completion
1281 @cindex word completion
1282 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1283 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1284 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1285 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1286
1287 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1288 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1289 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1290 enter it). For example, if you type
1291
1292 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1293 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1294 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1295 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1296 @smallexample
1297 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1298 @end smallexample
1299
1300 @noindent
1301 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1302 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1303
1304 @smallexample
1305 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1306 @end smallexample
1307
1308 @noindent
1309 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1310 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1311 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1312 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1313 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1314 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1315
1316 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1317 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1318 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1319 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1320 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1321 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1322 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1323 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1324 example:
1325
1326 @smallexample
1327 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1328 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1329 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1330 make_abs_section make_function_type
1331 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1332 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1333 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1334 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1335 @end smallexample
1336
1337 @noindent
1338 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1339 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1340 command.
1341
1342 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1343 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1344 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1345 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1346 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1347
1348 @cindex quotes in commands
1349 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1350 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1351 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1352 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1353 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1354 @value{GDBN} commands.
1355
1356 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1357 name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1358 overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1359 by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1360 may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1361 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1362 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1363 word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1364 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1365 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1366 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1367
1368 @smallexample
1369 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1370 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1371 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1372 @end smallexample
1373
1374 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1375 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1376 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1377 place:
1378
1379 @smallexample
1380 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1381 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1382 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1383 @end smallexample
1384
1385 @noindent
1386 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1387 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1388 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1389
1390 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1391 expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1392 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1393 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
1394
1395
1396 @node Help
1397 @section Getting help
1398 @cindex online documentation
1399 @kindex help
1400
1401 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1402 using the command @code{help}.
1403
1404 @table @code
1405 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1406 @item help
1407 @itemx h
1408 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1409 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1410
1411 @smallexample
1412 (@value{GDBP}) help
1413 List of classes of commands:
1414
1415 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1416 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1417 data -- Examining data
1418 files -- Specifying and examining files
1419 internals -- Maintenance commands
1420 obscure -- Obscure features
1421 running -- Running the program
1422 stack -- Examining the stack
1423 status -- Status inquiries
1424 support -- Support facilities
1425 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1426 stopping the program
1427 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1428
1429 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1430 commands in that class.
1431 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1432 documentation.
1433 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1434 (@value{GDBP})
1435 @end smallexample
1436 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1437
1438 @item help @var{class}
1439 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1440 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1441 help display for the class @code{status}:
1442
1443 @smallexample
1444 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1445 Status inquiries.
1446
1447 List of commands:
1448
1449 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1450 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1451 info -- Generic command for showing things
1452 about the program being debugged
1453 show -- Generic command for showing things
1454 about the debugger
1455
1456 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1457 documentation.
1458 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1459 (@value{GDBP})
1460 @end smallexample
1461
1462 @item help @var{command}
1463 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1464 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1465
1466 @kindex apropos
1467 @item apropos @var{args}
1468 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1469 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1470 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1471
1472 @smallexample
1473 apropos reload
1474 @end smallexample
1475
1476 @noindent
1477 results in:
1478
1479 @smallexample
1480 @c @group
1481 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1482 multiple times in one run
1483 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1484 multiple times in one run
1485 @c @end group
1486 @end smallexample
1487
1488 @kindex complete
1489 @item complete @var{args}
1490 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1491 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1492 command you want completed. For example:
1493
1494 @smallexample
1495 complete i
1496 @end smallexample
1497
1498 @noindent results in:
1499
1500 @smallexample
1501 @group
1502 if
1503 ignore
1504 info
1505 inspect
1506 @end group
1507 @end smallexample
1508
1509 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1510 @end table
1511
1512 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1513 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1514 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1515 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1516 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1517 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1518
1519 @c @group
1520 @table @code
1521 @kindex info
1522 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1523 @item info
1524 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1525 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1526 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1527 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1528 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1529 @w{@code{help info}}.
1530
1531 @kindex set
1532 @item set
1533 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1534 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1535 @code{set prompt $}.
1536
1537 @kindex show
1538 @item show
1539 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1540 @value{GDBN} itself.
1541 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1542 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1543 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1544 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1545
1546 @kindex info set
1547 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1548 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1549 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1550 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1551 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1552 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1553 @end table
1554 @c @end group
1555
1556 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1557 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1558
1559 @table @code
1560 @kindex show version
1561 @cindex version number
1562 @item show version
1563 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1564 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1565 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1566 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1567 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1568 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1569 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1570 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1571 @value{GDBN}.
1572
1573 @kindex show copying
1574 @item show copying
1575 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1576
1577 @kindex show warranty
1578 @item show warranty
1579 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1580 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1581
1582 @end table
1583
1584 @node Running
1585 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1586
1587 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1588 debugging information when you compile it.
1589
1590 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1591 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1592 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1593 kill a child process.
1594
1595 @menu
1596 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1597 * Starting:: Starting your program
1598 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1599 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1600
1601 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1602 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1603 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1604 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1605
1606 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1607 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1608 @end menu
1609
1610 @node Compilation
1611 @section Compiling for debugging
1612
1613 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1614 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1615 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1616 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1617 and addresses in the executable code.
1618
1619 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1620 the compiler.
1621
1622 Most compilers do not include information about preprocessor macros in
1623 the debugging information if you specify the @option{-g} flag alone,
1624 because this information is rather large. Version 3.1 of @value{NGCC},
1625 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you specify the
1626 options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3}; the former option requests
1627 debugging information in the Dwarf 2 format, and the latter requests
1628 ``extra information''. In the future, we hope to find more compact ways
1629 to represent macro information, so that it can be included with
1630 @option{-g} alone.
1631
1632 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1633 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1634 executables containing debugging information.
1635
1636 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1637 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1638 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1639 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1640 in pushing your luck.
1641
1642 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1643 @cindex debugging optimized code
1644 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1645 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1646 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1647 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1648 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1649 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1650
1651 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1652 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1653 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1654 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1655
1656 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1657 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1658 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1659
1660 @need 2000
1661 @node Starting
1662 @section Starting your program
1663 @cindex starting
1664 @cindex running
1665
1666 @table @code
1667 @kindex run
1668 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1669 @item run
1670 @itemx r
1671 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1672 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1673 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1674 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1675 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1676
1677 @end table
1678
1679 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1680 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1681 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1682 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1683
1684 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1685 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1686 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1687 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1688 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1689 divided into four categories:
1690
1691 @table @asis
1692 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1693 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1694 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1695 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1696 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1697 the arguments.
1698 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1699 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1700 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1701
1702 @item The @emph{environment.}
1703 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1704 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1705 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1706 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1707
1708 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1709 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1710 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1711 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1712
1713 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1714 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1715 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1716 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1717 set a different device for your program.
1718 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1719
1720 @cindex pipes
1721 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1722 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1723 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1724 wrong program.
1725 @end table
1726
1727 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1728 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1729 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1730 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1731 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1732
1733 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1734 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1735 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1736 your current breakpoints.
1737
1738 @node Arguments
1739 @section Your program's arguments
1740
1741 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1742 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1743 @code{run} command.
1744 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1745 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1746 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1747 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1748 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1749
1750 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1751 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1752 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1753 the program, not by the shell.
1754
1755 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1756 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1757
1758 @table @code
1759 @kindex set args
1760 @item set args
1761 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1762 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1763 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1764 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1765 it again without arguments.
1766
1767 @kindex show args
1768 @item show args
1769 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1770 @end table
1771
1772 @node Environment
1773 @section Your program's environment
1774
1775 @cindex environment (of your program)
1776 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1777 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1778 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1779 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1780 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1781 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1782 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1783
1784 @table @code
1785 @kindex path
1786 @item path @var{directory}
1787 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1788 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1789 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1790 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1791 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1792 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1793 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1794
1795 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1796 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1797 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1798 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1799 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1800 @var{directory} to the search path.
1801 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1802 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1803
1804 @kindex show paths
1805 @item show paths
1806 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1807 environment variable).
1808
1809 @kindex show environment
1810 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1811 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1812 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1813 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1814 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1815
1816 @kindex set environment
1817 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1818 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1819 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1820 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1821 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1822 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1823 null value.
1824 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1825 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1826
1827 For example, this command:
1828
1829 @smallexample
1830 set env USER = foo
1831 @end smallexample
1832
1833 @noindent
1834 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1835 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1836 are not actually required.)
1837
1838 @kindex unset environment
1839 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1840 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1841 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1842 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1843 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1844 @end table
1845
1846 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1847 the shell indicated
1848 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1849 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1850 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1851 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1852 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1853 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1854 @file{.profile}.
1855
1856 @node Working Directory
1857 @section Your program's working directory
1858
1859 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1860 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1861 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1862 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1863 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1864 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1865
1866 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1867 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1868 specify files}.
1869
1870 @table @code
1871 @kindex cd
1872 @item cd @var{directory}
1873 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1874
1875 @kindex pwd
1876 @item pwd
1877 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1878 @end table
1879
1880 @node Input/Output
1881 @section Your program's input and output
1882
1883 @cindex redirection
1884 @cindex i/o
1885 @cindex terminal
1886 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1887 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1888 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1889 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1890 running your program.
1891
1892 @table @code
1893 @kindex info terminal
1894 @item info terminal
1895 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1896 program is using.
1897 @end table
1898
1899 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1900 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1901
1902 @smallexample
1903 run > outfile
1904 @end smallexample
1905
1906 @noindent
1907 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1908
1909 @kindex tty
1910 @cindex controlling terminal
1911 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1912 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1913 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1914 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1915 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1916
1917 @smallexample
1918 tty /dev/ttyb
1919 @end smallexample
1920
1921 @noindent
1922 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1923 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1924 that as their controlling terminal.
1925
1926 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1927 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1928 terminal.
1929
1930 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1931 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1932 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1933
1934 @node Attach
1935 @section Debugging an already-running process
1936 @kindex attach
1937 @cindex attach
1938
1939 @table @code
1940 @item attach @var{process-id}
1941 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1942 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1943 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1944 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1945 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1946
1947 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1948 executing the command.
1949 @end table
1950
1951 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1952 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1953 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1954 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1955
1956 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1957 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1958 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1959 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1960 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1961 Specify Files}.
1962
1963 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1964 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1965 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1966 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1967 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1968 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1969 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1970
1971 @table @code
1972 @kindex detach
1973 @item detach
1974 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1975 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1976 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1977 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1978 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1979 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1980 executing the command.
1981 @end table
1982
1983 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1984 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1985 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1986 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1987 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1988 messages}).
1989
1990 @node Kill Process
1991 @section Killing the child process
1992
1993 @table @code
1994 @kindex kill
1995 @item kill
1996 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1997 @end table
1998
1999 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2000 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2001 is running.
2002
2003 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2004 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2005 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2006 outside the debugger.
2007
2008 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2009 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2010 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2011 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2012 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2013 breakpoint settings).
2014
2015 @node Threads
2016 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
2017
2018 @cindex threads of execution
2019 @cindex multiple threads
2020 @cindex switching threads
2021 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2022 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2023 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2024 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2025 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2026 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2027 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2028
2029 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2030 programs:
2031
2032 @itemize @bullet
2033 @item automatic notification of new threads
2034 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2035 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2036 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
2037 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2038 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2039 @end itemize
2040
2041 @quotation
2042 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2043 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2044 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2045 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2046 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2047 like this:
2048
2049 @smallexample
2050 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2051 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2052 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2053 see the IDs of currently known threads.
2054 @end smallexample
2055 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2056 @c doesn't support threads"?
2057 @end quotation
2058
2059 @cindex focus of debugging
2060 @cindex current thread
2061 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2062 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2063 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2064 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2065 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2066
2067 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2068 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2069 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2070 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2071 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2072 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2073 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2074 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2075 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2076 LynxOS, you might see
2077
2078 @smallexample
2079 [New process 35 thread 27]
2080 @end smallexample
2081
2082 @noindent
2083 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2084 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2085 further qualifier.
2086
2087 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2088 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2089 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2090 @c program?
2091 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2092 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2093 @c threads ab initio?
2094
2095 @cindex thread number
2096 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2097 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2098 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2099
2100 @table @code
2101 @kindex info threads
2102 @item info threads
2103 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2104 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2105
2106 @enumerate
2107 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2108
2109 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2110
2111 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2112 @end enumerate
2113
2114 @noindent
2115 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2116 indicates the current thread.
2117
2118 For example,
2119 @end table
2120 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2121
2122 @smallexample
2123 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2124 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2125 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2126 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2127 at threadtest.c:68
2128 @end smallexample
2129
2130 On HP-UX systems:
2131
2132 @cindex thread number
2133 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2134 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2135 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2136 thread in your program.
2137
2138 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2139 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2140 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2141 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2142 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2143 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2144 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2145 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2146 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2147 HP-UX, you see
2148
2149 @smallexample
2150 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2151 @end smallexample
2152
2153 @noindent
2154 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2155
2156 @table @code
2157 @kindex info threads
2158 @item info threads
2159 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2160 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2161
2162 @enumerate
2163 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2164
2165 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2166
2167 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2168 @end enumerate
2169
2170 @noindent
2171 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2172 indicates the current thread.
2173
2174 For example,
2175 @end table
2176 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2177
2178 @smallexample
2179 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2180 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2181 at quicksort.c:137
2182 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2183 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2184 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2185 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2186 @end smallexample
2187
2188 @table @code
2189 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2190 @item thread @var{threadno}
2191 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2192 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2193 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2194 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2195 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2196
2197 @smallexample
2198 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2199 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2200 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2201 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2202 @end smallexample
2203
2204 @noindent
2205 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2206 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2207 threads.
2208
2209 @kindex thread apply
2210 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2211 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2212 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2213 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2214 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2215 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2216 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2217 @end table
2218
2219 @cindex automatic thread selection
2220 @cindex switching threads automatically
2221 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2222 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2223 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2224 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2225 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2226 thread.
2227
2228 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2229 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2230 programs with multiple threads.
2231
2232 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2233 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2234
2235 @node Processes
2236 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2237
2238 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2239 @cindex multiple processes
2240 @cindex processes, multiple
2241 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2242 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2243 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2244 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2245 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2246 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2247 will cause it to terminate.
2248
2249 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2250 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2251 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2252 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2253 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2254 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2255 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2256 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2257 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2258 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2259
2260 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2261 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2262 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2263
2264 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2265 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2266
2267 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2268 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2269
2270 @table @code
2271 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2272 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2273 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2274 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2275 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2276
2277 @table @code
2278 @item parent
2279 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2280 unimpeded. This is the default.
2281
2282 @item child
2283 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2284 unimpeded.
2285
2286 @item ask
2287 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2288 @end table
2289
2290 @item show follow-fork-mode
2291 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2292 @end table
2293
2294 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2295 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2296 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2297 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2298 the child process's @code{main}.
2299
2300 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2301 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2302
2303 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2304 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2305 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2306 argument.
2307
2308 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2309 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2310 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2311
2312 @node Stopping
2313 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2314
2315 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2316 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2317 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2318
2319 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2320 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2321 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2322 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2323 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2324 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2325 explicitly request this information at any time.
2326
2327 @table @code
2328 @kindex info program
2329 @item info program
2330 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2331 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2332 @end table
2333
2334 @menu
2335 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2336 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2337 * Signals:: Signals
2338 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2339 @end menu
2340
2341 @node Breakpoints
2342 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2343
2344 @cindex breakpoints
2345 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2346 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2347 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2348 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2349 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2350 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2351 program.
2352
2353 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2354 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2355 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2356 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2357 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2358 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2359
2360 @cindex watchpoints
2361 @cindex memory tracing
2362 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2363 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2364 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2365 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2366 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2367 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2368 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2369 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2370
2371 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2372 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2373 Automatic display}.
2374
2375 @cindex catchpoints
2376 @cindex breakpoint on events
2377 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2378 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
2379 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2380 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2381 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2382 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2383 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2384
2385 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2386 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2387 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2388 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2389 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2390 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2391 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2392 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2393 enable it again.
2394
2395 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2396 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2397 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2398 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2399 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2400 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2401 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2402
2403 @menu
2404 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2405 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2406 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2407 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2408 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2409 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2410 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2411 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2412 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2413 @end menu
2414
2415 @node Set Breaks
2416 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2417
2418 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2419 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2420 @c
2421 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2422
2423 @kindex break
2424 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2425 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2426 @cindex latest breakpoint
2427 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2428 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2429 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2430 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2431 convenience variables.
2432
2433 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2434
2435 @table @code
2436 @item break @var{function}
2437 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2438 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2439 C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2440 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2441
2442 @item break +@var{offset}
2443 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2444 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2445 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2446 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2447
2448 @item break @var{linenum}
2449 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2450 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2451 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2452 code on that line.
2453
2454 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2455 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2456
2457 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2458 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2459 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2460 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2461 functions.
2462
2463 @item break *@var{address}
2464 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2465 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2466 information or source files.
2467
2468 @item break
2469 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2470 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2471 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2472 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2473 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2474 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2475 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2476 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2477 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2478 inside loops.
2479
2480 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2481 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2482 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2483 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2484 existed when your program stopped.
2485
2486 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2487 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2488 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2489 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2490 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2491 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2492 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2493
2494 @kindex tbreak
2495 @item tbreak @var{args}
2496 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2497 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2498 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2499 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2500
2501 @kindex hbreak
2502 @item hbreak @var{args}
2503 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2504 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2505 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2506 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2507 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2508 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2509 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2510 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2511 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2512 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2513 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2514 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2515 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2516 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2517 @xref{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
2518
2519
2520 @kindex thbreak
2521 @item thbreak @var{args}
2522 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2523 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2524 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2525 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2526 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2527 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2528 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2529 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2530
2531 @kindex rbreak
2532 @cindex regular expression
2533 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2534 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2535 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2536 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2537 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2538 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2539 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2540
2541 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2542 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2543 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2544 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2545 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2546 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2547
2548 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2549 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2550 classes.
2551
2552 @kindex info breakpoints
2553 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2554 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2555 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2556 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2557 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2558 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2559
2560 @table @emph
2561 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2562 @item Type
2563 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2564 @item Disposition
2565 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2566 @item Enabled or Disabled
2567 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2568 that are not enabled.
2569 @item Address
2570 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2571 @item What
2572 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2573 line number.
2574 @end table
2575
2576 @noindent
2577 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2578 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2579 are listed after that.
2580
2581 @noindent
2582 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2583 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2584 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2585 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2586 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2587
2588 @noindent
2589 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2590 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2591 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2592 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2593 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2594 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2595 @end table
2596
2597 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2598 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2599 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2600 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2601
2602 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2603 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2604 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2605 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2606 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2607 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2608 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2609 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
2610
2611
2612 @node Set Watchpoints
2613 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2614
2615 @cindex setting watchpoints
2616 @cindex software watchpoints
2617 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2618 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2619 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2620 this may happen.
2621
2622 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2623 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2624 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2625 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2626 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2627 culprit.)
2628
2629 On some systems, such as HP-UX, @sc{gnu}/Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2630 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2631 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2632 program.
2633
2634 @table @code
2635 @kindex watch
2636 @item watch @var{expr}
2637 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2638 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2639
2640 @kindex rwatch
2641 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2642 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2643
2644 @kindex awatch
2645 @item awatch @var{expr}
2646 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2647 by the program.
2648
2649 @kindex info watchpoints
2650 @item info watchpoints
2651 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2652 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2653 @end table
2654
2655 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2656 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2657 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2658 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2659 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2660 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2661
2662 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2663
2664 @smallexample
2665 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2666 @end smallexample
2667
2668 @noindent
2669 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2670
2671 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2672 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2673 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2674 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2675 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2676 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2677 will print a message like this:
2678
2679 @smallexample
2680 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2681 @end smallexample
2682
2683 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2684 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2685 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2686 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2687 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2688 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2689 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2690 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2691
2692 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2693 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2694 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2695 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2696 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2697 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2698
2699 @smallexample
2700 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2701 @end smallexample
2702
2703 @noindent
2704 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2705
2706 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2707 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2708 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2709 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2710 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2711 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2712 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2713 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2714 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2715 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2716
2717 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2718 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2719 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2720
2721 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2722 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2723 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2724 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2725 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2726 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2727 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2728 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2729 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2730
2731 @quotation
2732 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2733 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2734 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2735 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2736 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2737 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2738 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2739 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2740 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2741 the expression.
2742
2743 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2744 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2745 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2746 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2747 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2748 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2749 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2750 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2751 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2752 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2753 @end quotation
2754
2755 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
2756
2757 @node Set Catchpoints
2758 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2759 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2760 @cindex exception handlers
2761 @cindex event handling
2762
2763 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2764 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
2765 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2766
2767 @table @code
2768 @kindex catch
2769 @item catch @var{event}
2770 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2771 @table @code
2772 @item throw
2773 @kindex catch throw
2774 The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
2775
2776 @item catch
2777 @kindex catch catch
2778 The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
2779
2780 @item exec
2781 @kindex catch exec
2782 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2783
2784 @item fork
2785 @kindex catch fork
2786 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2787
2788 @item vfork
2789 @kindex catch vfork
2790 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2791
2792 @item load
2793 @itemx load @var{libname}
2794 @kindex catch load
2795 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2796 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2797
2798 @item unload
2799 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2800 @kindex catch unload
2801 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2802 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2803 @end table
2804
2805 @item tcatch @var{event}
2806 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2807 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2808
2809 @end table
2810
2811 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2812
2813 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
2814 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2815
2816 @itemize @bullet
2817 @item
2818 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2819 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2820 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2821 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2822 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2823 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2824 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2825 disabled within interactive calls.
2826
2827 @item
2828 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2829
2830 @item
2831 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2832 @end itemize
2833
2834 @cindex raise exceptions
2835 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2836 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2837 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2838 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2839 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2840 out where the exception was raised.
2841
2842 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2843 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
2844 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2845 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2846
2847 @smallexample
2848 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2849 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2850 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2851 @end smallexample
2852
2853 @noindent
2854 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2855 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2856 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2857
2858 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2859 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2860 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2861 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2862 raised.
2863
2864
2865 @node Delete Breaks
2866 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2867
2868 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2869 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2870 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2871 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2872 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2873 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2874
2875 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2876 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2877 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2878 their breakpoint numbers.
2879
2880 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2881 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2882 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2883
2884 @table @code
2885 @kindex clear
2886 @item clear
2887 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2888 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2889 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2890 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2891
2892 @item clear @var{function}
2893 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2894 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2895
2896 @item clear @var{linenum}
2897 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2898 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2899
2900 @cindex delete breakpoints
2901 @kindex delete
2902 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2903 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2904 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2905 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2906 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2907 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2908 @end table
2909
2910 @node Disabling
2911 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2912
2913 @kindex disable breakpoints
2914 @kindex enable breakpoints
2915 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2916 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2917 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2918 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2919
2920 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2921 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2922 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2923 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2924 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2925
2926 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2927 states of enablement:
2928
2929 @itemize @bullet
2930 @item
2931 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2932 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2933 @item
2934 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2935 @item
2936 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2937 disabled.
2938 @item
2939 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2940 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2941 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2942 @end itemize
2943
2944 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2945 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2946
2947 @table @code
2948 @kindex disable breakpoints
2949 @kindex disable
2950 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2951 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2952 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2953 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2954 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2955 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2956 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2957
2958 @kindex enable breakpoints
2959 @kindex enable
2960 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2961 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2962 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2963
2964 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2965 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2966 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2967
2968 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2969 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2970 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2971 @end table
2972
2973 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2974 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2975 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2976 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2977 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2978 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2979 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2980 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2981 stepping}.)
2982
2983 @node Conditions
2984 @subsection Break conditions
2985 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2986 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2987
2988 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2989 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2990 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2991 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2992 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2993 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2994 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2995 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2996
2997 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2998 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2999 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
3000 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
3001 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
3002
3003 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
3004 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
3005 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
3006 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
3007 one.
3008
3009 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
3010 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
3011 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
3012 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
3013 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
3014 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
3015 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
3016 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
3017 conditions for the
3018 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
3019 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
3020
3021 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
3022 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
3023 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
3024 with the @code{condition} command.
3025
3026 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3027 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3028 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3029 catchpoint.
3030
3031 @table @code
3032 @kindex condition
3033 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3034 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3035 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3036 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3037 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3038 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3039 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
3040 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3041 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3042 prints an error message:
3043
3044 @smallexample
3045 No symbol "foo" in current context.
3046 @end smallexample
3047
3048 @noindent
3049 @value{GDBN} does
3050 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
3051 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3052 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
3053
3054 @item condition @var{bnum}
3055 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3056 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3057 @end table
3058
3059 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3060 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3061 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3062 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3063 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3064 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3065 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3066 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3067 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3068 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3069 your program reaches it.
3070
3071 @table @code
3072 @kindex ignore
3073 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3074 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3075 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3076 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3077 takes no action.
3078
3079 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3080 a count of zero.
3081
3082 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3083 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3084 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3085 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3086
3087 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3088 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3089 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3090
3091 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3092 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3093 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3094 variables}.
3095 @end table
3096
3097 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3098
3099
3100 @node Break Commands
3101 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3102
3103 @cindex breakpoint commands
3104 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3105 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3106 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3107 enable other breakpoints.
3108
3109 @table @code
3110 @kindex commands
3111 @kindex end
3112 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3113 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3114 @itemx end
3115 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3116 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3117 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3118
3119 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3120 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3121
3122 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3123 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3124 recently encountered).
3125 @end table
3126
3127 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3128 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3129
3130 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3131 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3132 that resumes execution.
3133
3134 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3135 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3136 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3137 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3138 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3139
3140 @kindex silent
3141 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3142 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3143 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3144 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3145 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3146 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3147
3148 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3149 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3150 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3151
3152 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3153 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3154
3155 @smallexample
3156 break foo if x>0
3157 commands
3158 silent
3159 printf "x is %d\n",x
3160 cont
3161 end
3162 @end smallexample
3163
3164 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3165 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3166 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3167 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3168 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3169 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3170 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3171
3172 @smallexample
3173 break 403
3174 commands
3175 silent
3176 set x = y + 4
3177 cont
3178 end
3179 @end smallexample
3180
3181 @node Breakpoint Menus
3182 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3183 @cindex overloading
3184 @cindex symbol overloading
3185
3186 Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
3187 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3188 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3189 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3190 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3191 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3192 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3193 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3194 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3195 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3196 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3197 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3198 breakpoints.
3199
3200 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3201 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3202 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3203
3204 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3205 @smallexample
3206 @group
3207 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3208 [0] cancel
3209 [1] all
3210 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3211 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3212 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3213 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3214 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3215 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3216 > 2 4 6
3217 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3218 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3219 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3220 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3221 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3222 breakpoints.
3223 (@value{GDBP})
3224 @end group
3225 @end smallexample
3226
3227 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3228 @node Error in Breakpoints
3229 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3230 @c
3231 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3232 @c
3233 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3234 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3235 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3236 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3237
3238 @smallexample
3239 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3240 The same program may be running in another process.
3241 @end smallexample
3242
3243 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3244
3245 @enumerate
3246 @item
3247 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3248
3249 @item
3250 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3251 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3252 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3253 Then start your program again.
3254
3255 @item
3256 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3257 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3258 to nonsharable executables.
3259 @end enumerate
3260 @c @end ifclear
3261
3262 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3263 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3264
3265 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3266 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3267 @smallexample
3268 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3269 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3270 @end smallexample
3271
3272 @noindent
3273 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3274 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3275 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3276
3277 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3278 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3279
3280
3281 @node Continuing and Stepping
3282 @section Continuing and stepping
3283
3284 @cindex stepping
3285 @cindex continuing
3286 @cindex resuming execution
3287 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3288 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3289 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3290 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3291 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3292 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3293 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3294 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3295
3296 @table @code
3297 @kindex continue
3298 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3299 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3300 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3301 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3302 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3303 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3304 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3305 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3306 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3307 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3308
3309 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3310 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3311 @code{continue} is ignored.
3312
3313 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3314 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3315 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3316 @code{continue}.
3317 @end table
3318
3319 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3320 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3321 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3322 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3323
3324 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3325 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3326 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3327 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3328 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3329 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3330
3331 @table @code
3332 @kindex step
3333 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3334 @item step
3335 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3336 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3337 abbreviated @code{s}.
3338
3339 @quotation
3340 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3341 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3342 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3343 @c distinction here.
3344 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3345 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3346 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3347 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3348 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3349 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3350 below.
3351 @end quotation
3352
3353 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3354 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3355 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3356 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3357 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3358 called within the line.
3359
3360 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3361 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3362 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3363 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3364 was any debugging information about the routine.
3365
3366 @item step @var{count}
3367 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3368 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3369 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3370
3371 @kindex next
3372 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3373 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3374 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3375 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3376 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3377 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3378 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3379 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3380
3381 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3382
3383
3384 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3385 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3386 @c
3387 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3388 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3389 @c function are executed without stopping.
3390
3391 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3392 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3393 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3394
3395 @kindex set step-mode
3396 @item set step-mode
3397 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3398 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3399 @itemx set step-mode on
3400 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3401 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3402 information rather than stepping over it.
3403
3404 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3405 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3406 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3407
3408 @item set step-mode off
3409 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3410 debug information. This is the default.
3411
3412 @kindex finish
3413 @item finish
3414 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3415 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3416
3417 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3418 ,Returning from a function}).
3419
3420 @kindex until
3421 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3422 @item until
3423 @itemx u
3424 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3425 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3426 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3427 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3428 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3429 than the address of the jump.
3430
3431 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3432 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3433 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3434 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3435 through the next iteration.
3436
3437 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3438 stack frame.
3439
3440 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3441 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3442 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3443 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3444 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3445
3446 @smallexample
3447 (@value{GDBP}) f
3448 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3449 206 expand_input();
3450 (@value{GDBP}) until
3451 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3452 @end smallexample
3453
3454 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3455 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3456 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3457 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3458 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3459 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3460 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3461
3462 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3463 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3464 argument.
3465
3466 @item until @var{location}
3467 @itemx u @var{location}
3468 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3469 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3470 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3471 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints, and
3472 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
3473 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
3474 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
3475 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
3476 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
3477 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e. after the inner
3478 invocations have returned.
3479
3480 @smallexample
3481 94 int factorial (int value)
3482 95 @{
3483 96 if (value > 1) @{
3484 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
3485 98 @}
3486 99 return (value);
3487 100 @}
3488 @end smallexample
3489
3490
3491 @kindex advance @var{location}
3492 @itemx advance @var{location}
3493 Continue running the program up to the given location. An argument is
3494 required, anything of the same form as arguments for the @code{break}
3495 command. Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
3496 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
3497 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
3498 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
3499
3500
3501 @kindex stepi
3502 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3503 @item stepi
3504 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3505 @itemx si
3506 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3507
3508 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3509 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3510 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3511 Display,, Automatic display}.
3512
3513 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3514
3515 @need 750
3516 @kindex nexti
3517 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3518 @item nexti
3519 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3520 @itemx ni
3521 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3522 proceed until the function returns.
3523
3524 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3525 @end table
3526
3527 @node Signals
3528 @section Signals
3529 @cindex signals
3530
3531 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3532 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3533 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3534 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3535 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3536 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3537 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3538 requested an alarm).
3539
3540 @cindex fatal signals
3541 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3542 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3543 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3544 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3545 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3546 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3547
3548 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3549 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3550 signal.
3551
3552 @cindex handling signals
3553 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3554 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3555 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
3556 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3557 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3558
3559 @table @code
3560 @kindex info signals
3561 @item info signals
3562 @itemx info handle
3563 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3564 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3565 the defined types of signals.
3566
3567 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3568
3569 @kindex handle
3570 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3571 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3572 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
3573 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
3574 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3575 known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3576 @end table
3577
3578 @c @group
3579 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3580 Their full names are:
3581
3582 @table @code
3583 @item nostop
3584 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3585 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3586
3587 @item stop
3588 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3589 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3590
3591 @item print
3592 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3593
3594 @item noprint
3595 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3596 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3597
3598 @item pass
3599 @itemx noignore
3600 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3601 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3602 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
3603
3604 @item nopass
3605 @itemx ignore
3606 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3607 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
3608 @end table
3609 @c @end group
3610
3611 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3612 program until you
3613 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3614 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3615 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3616 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3617 program sees that signal when you continue.
3618
3619 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3620 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3621 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3622 erroneous signals.
3623
3624 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3625 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3626 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3627 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3628 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3629 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3630 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3631 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3632 program a signal}.
3633
3634 @node Thread Stops
3635 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3636
3637 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3638 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3639 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3640
3641 @table @code
3642 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3643 @cindex thread breakpoints
3644 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3645 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3646 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3647 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3648 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3649
3650 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3651 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3652 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3653 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3654 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3655
3656 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3657 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3658 program.
3659
3660 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3661 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3662 breakpoint condition, like this:
3663
3664 @smallexample
3665 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3666 @end smallexample
3667
3668 @end table
3669
3670 @cindex stopped threads
3671 @cindex threads, stopped
3672 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3673 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3674 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3675 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3676 underfoot.
3677
3678 @cindex continuing threads
3679 @cindex threads, continuing
3680 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3681 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3682 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3683
3684 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3685 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3686 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3687 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3688 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3689 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3690 stops.
3691
3692 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3693 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3694 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3695 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3696
3697 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3698 thread to run.
3699
3700 @table @code
3701 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3702 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3703 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3704 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3705 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3706 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3707 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3708 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3709 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3710 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3711 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3712 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3713
3714 @item show scheduler-locking
3715 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3716 @end table
3717
3718
3719 @node Stack
3720 @chapter Examining the Stack
3721
3722 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3723 stopped and how it got there.
3724
3725 @cindex call stack
3726 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3727 is generated.
3728 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3729 the arguments of the call,
3730 and the local variables of the function being called.
3731 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3732 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3733 stack}.
3734
3735 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3736 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3737
3738 @cindex selected frame
3739 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3740 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3741 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3742 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3743 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3744 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3745
3746 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3747 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3748 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3749
3750 @menu
3751 * Frames:: Stack frames
3752 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3753 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3754 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3755
3756 @end menu
3757
3758 @node Frames
3759 @section Stack frames
3760
3761 @cindex frame, definition
3762 @cindex stack frame
3763 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3764 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3765 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3766 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3767 which the function is executing.
3768
3769 @cindex initial frame
3770 @cindex outermost frame
3771 @cindex innermost frame
3772 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3773 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3774 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3775 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3776 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3777 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3778 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3779 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3780
3781 @cindex frame pointer
3782 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3783 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3784 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3785 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3786 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3787 going on in that frame.
3788
3789 @cindex frame number
3790 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3791 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3792 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3793 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3794 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3795
3796 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3797 @c underflow problems.
3798 @cindex frameless execution
3799 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3800 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3801 @smallexample
3802 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3803 @end smallexample
3804 generates functions without a frame.)
3805 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3806 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3807 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3808 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3809 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3810 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3811 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3812
3813 @table @code
3814 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3815 @cindex current stack frame
3816 @item frame @var{args}
3817 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3818 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3819 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3820 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3821
3822 @kindex select-frame
3823 @cindex selecting frame silently
3824 @item select-frame
3825 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3826 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3827 @code{frame}.
3828 @end table
3829
3830 @node Backtrace
3831 @section Backtraces
3832
3833 @cindex backtraces
3834 @cindex tracebacks
3835 @cindex stack traces
3836 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3837 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3838 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3839 stack.
3840
3841 @table @code
3842 @kindex backtrace
3843 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3844 @item backtrace
3845 @itemx bt
3846 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3847 frames in the stack.
3848
3849 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3850 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3851
3852 @item backtrace @var{n}
3853 @itemx bt @var{n}
3854 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3855
3856 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3857 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3858 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3859 @end table
3860
3861 @kindex where
3862 @kindex info stack
3863 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3864 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3865 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3866
3867 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3868 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3869 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3870 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3871 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3872 line number.
3873
3874 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3875 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3876
3877 @smallexample
3878 @group
3879 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3880 at builtin.c:993
3881 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3882 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3883 at macro.c:71
3884 (More stack frames follow...)
3885 @end group
3886 @end smallexample
3887
3888 @noindent
3889 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3890 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3891 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3892
3893 @kindex set backtrace-below-main
3894 @kindex show backtrace-below-main
3895
3896 Most programs have a standard entry point---a place where system libraries
3897 and startup code transition into user code. For C this is @code{main}.
3898 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace it will terminate
3899 the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly system-specific (and generally
3900 uninteresting) code. If you need to examine the startup code, then you can
3901 change this behavior.
3902
3903 @table @code
3904 @item set backtrace-below-main off
3905 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
3906 default.
3907
3908 @item set backtrace-below-main
3909 @itemx set backtrace-below-main on
3910 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point to the top of the stack.
3911
3912 @item show backtrace-below-main
3913 Display the current backtrace policy.
3914 @end table
3915
3916 @node Selection
3917 @section Selecting a frame
3918
3919 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3920 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3921 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3922 of the stack frame just selected.
3923
3924 @table @code
3925 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3926 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3927 @item frame @var{n}
3928 @itemx f @var{n}
3929 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3930 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3931 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3932 @code{main}.
3933
3934 @item frame @var{addr}
3935 @itemx f @var{addr}
3936 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3937 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3938 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3939 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3940 switches between them.
3941
3942 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3943 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3944
3945 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3946 pointer and a program counter.
3947
3948 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3949 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3950 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3951 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3952 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3953
3954 @kindex up
3955 @item up @var{n}
3956 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3957 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3958 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3959
3960 @kindex down
3961 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3962 @item down @var{n}
3963 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3964 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3965 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3966 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3967 @end table
3968
3969 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3970 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3971 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3972 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3973
3974 @need 1000
3975 For example:
3976
3977 @smallexample
3978 @group
3979 (@value{GDBP}) up
3980 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3981 at env.c:10
3982 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3983 @end group
3984 @end smallexample
3985
3986 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3987 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3988 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
3989 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
3990 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines},
3991 for details.
3992
3993 @table @code
3994 @kindex down-silently
3995 @kindex up-silently
3996 @item up-silently @var{n}
3997 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3998 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3999 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
4000 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
4001 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
4002 distracting.
4003 @end table
4004
4005 @node Frame Info
4006 @section Information about a frame
4007
4008 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
4009 stack frame.
4010
4011 @table @code
4012 @item frame
4013 @itemx f
4014 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
4015 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
4016 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
4017 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
4018 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4019
4020 @kindex info frame
4021 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
4022 @item info frame
4023 @itemx info f
4024 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
4025 including:
4026
4027 @itemize @bullet
4028 @item
4029 the address of the frame
4030 @item
4031 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
4032 @item
4033 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
4034 @item
4035 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
4036 @item
4037 the address of the frame's arguments
4038 @item
4039 the address of the frame's local variables
4040 @item
4041 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
4042 @item
4043 which registers were saved in the frame
4044 @end itemize
4045
4046 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
4047 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
4048 the usual conventions.
4049
4050 @item info frame @var{addr}
4051 @itemx info f @var{addr}
4052 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
4053 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
4054 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
4055 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
4056 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
4057
4058 @kindex info args
4059 @item info args
4060 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
4061
4062 @item info locals
4063 @kindex info locals
4064 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
4065 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
4066 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
4067
4068 @kindex info catch
4069 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
4070 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
4071 @item info catch
4072 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
4073 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
4074 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
4075 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
4076 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
4077
4078 @end table
4079
4080
4081 @node Source
4082 @chapter Examining Source Files
4083
4084 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4085 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4086 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4087 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4088 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4089 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4090 source files by explicit command.
4091
4092 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
4093 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
4094 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
4095
4096 @menu
4097 * List:: Printing source lines
4098 * Edit:: Editing source files
4099 * Search:: Searching source files
4100 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4101 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4102 @end menu
4103
4104 @node List
4105 @section Printing source lines
4106
4107 @kindex list
4108 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
4109 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
4110 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
4111 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4112
4113 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4114
4115 @table @code
4116 @item list @var{linenum}
4117 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4118 current source file.
4119
4120 @item list @var{function}
4121 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4122 @var{function}.
4123
4124 @item list
4125 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4126 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4127 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4128 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4129 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4130
4131 @item list -
4132 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4133 @end table
4134
4135 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4136 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4137
4138 @table @code
4139 @kindex set listsize
4140 @item set listsize @var{count}
4141 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4142 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4143
4144 @kindex show listsize
4145 @item show listsize
4146 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4147 @end table
4148
4149 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4150 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4151 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4152 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4153 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4154
4155 @cindex linespec
4156 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4157 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4158 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4159 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4160
4161 @table @code
4162 @item list @var{linespec}
4163 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4164
4165 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4166 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4167 linespecs.
4168
4169 @item list ,@var{last}
4170 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4171
4172 @item list @var{first},
4173 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4174
4175 @item list +
4176 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4177
4178 @item list -
4179 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4180
4181 @item list
4182 As described in the preceding table.
4183 @end table
4184
4185 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4186 kinds of linespec.
4187
4188 @table @code
4189 @item @var{number}
4190 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4191 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4192 the same source file as the first linespec.
4193
4194 @item +@var{offset}
4195 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4196 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4197 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4198 first linespec.
4199
4200 @item -@var{offset}
4201 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4202
4203 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4204 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4205
4206 @item @var{function}
4207 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4208 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4209
4210 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4211 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4212 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4213 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4214 identically named functions in different source files.
4215
4216 @item *@var{address}
4217 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4218 @var{address} may be any expression.
4219 @end table
4220
4221 @node Edit
4222 @section Editing source files
4223 @cindex editing source files
4224
4225 @kindex edit
4226 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
4227 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
4228 The editing program of your choice
4229 is invoked with the current line set to
4230 the active line in the program.
4231 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
4232 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program.
4233
4234 Here are the forms of the @code{edit} command most commonly used:
4235
4236 @table @code
4237 @item edit
4238 Edit the current source file at the active line number in the program.
4239
4240 @item edit @var{number}
4241 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
4242
4243 @item edit @var{function}
4244 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
4245
4246 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{number}
4247 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4248
4249 @item edit @var{filename}:@var{function}
4250 Specifies the line that begins the body of the
4251 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4252 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4253 identically named functions in different source files.
4254
4255 @item edit *@var{address}
4256 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4257 @var{address} may be any expression.
4258 @end table
4259
4260 @subsection Choosing your editor
4261 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
4262 @footnote{
4263 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
4264 following command-line syntax:
4265 @smallexample
4266 ex +@var{number} file
4267 @end smallexample
4268 The optional numeric value +@var{number} designates the active line in
4269 the file.}. By default, it is @value{EDITOR}, but you can change this
4270 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
4271 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
4272 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
4273 @smallexample
4274 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
4275 export EDITOR
4276 gdb ...
4277 @end smallexample
4278 or in the @code{csh} shell,
4279 @smallexample
4280 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
4281 gdb ...
4282 @end smallexample
4283
4284 @node Search
4285 @section Searching source files
4286 @cindex searching
4287 @kindex reverse-search
4288
4289 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4290 regular expression.
4291
4292 @table @code
4293 @kindex search
4294 @kindex forward-search
4295 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4296 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4297 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4298 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4299 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4300 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4301 @code{fo}.
4302
4303 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4304 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4305 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4306 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4307 this command as @code{rev}.
4308 @end table
4309
4310 @node Source Path
4311 @section Specifying source directories
4312
4313 @cindex source path
4314 @cindex directories for source files
4315 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4316 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4317 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4318 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4319 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4320 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4321 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4322 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4323 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4324 path.
4325
4326 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4327 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4328 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4329 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4330 last resort.
4331
4332 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4333 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4334 each line is in the file.
4335
4336 @kindex directory
4337 @kindex dir
4338 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4339 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4340 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4341
4342 @table @code
4343 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4344 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4345 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4346 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4347 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4348 part of absolute file names) or
4349 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4350 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4351
4352 @kindex cdir
4353 @kindex cwd
4354 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4355 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4356 @cindex compilation directory
4357 @cindex current directory
4358 @cindex working directory
4359 @cindex directory, current
4360 @cindex directory, compilation
4361 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4362 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4363 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4364 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4365 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4366 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4367
4368 @item directory
4369 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4370
4371 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4372 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4373
4374 @item show directories
4375 @kindex show directories
4376 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4377 @end table
4378
4379 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4380 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4381 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4382
4383 @enumerate
4384 @item
4385 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4386
4387 @item
4388 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4389 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4390 directories in one command.
4391 @end enumerate
4392
4393 @node Machine Code
4394 @section Source and machine code
4395
4396 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4397 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4398 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4399 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4400 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4401 well as hex.
4402
4403 @table @code
4404 @kindex info line
4405 @item info line @var{linespec}
4406 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4407 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4408 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4409 source lines}).
4410 @end table
4411
4412 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4413 the object code for the first line of function
4414 @code{m4_changequote}:
4415
4416 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4417 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4418 @smallexample
4419 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4420 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4421 @end smallexample
4422
4423 @noindent
4424 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4425 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4426 @smallexample
4427 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4428 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4429 @end smallexample
4430
4431 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4432 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4433 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4434 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4435 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4436 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4437 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4438 variables}).
4439
4440 @table @code
4441 @kindex disassemble
4442 @cindex assembly instructions
4443 @cindex instructions, assembly
4444 @cindex machine instructions
4445 @cindex listing machine instructions
4446 @item disassemble
4447 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4448 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4449 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4450 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4451 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4452 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4453 @end table
4454
4455 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4456 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4457
4458 @smallexample
4459 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4460 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4461 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4462 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4463 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4464 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4465 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4466 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4467 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4468 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4469 End of assembler dump.
4470 @end smallexample
4471
4472 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4473 mnemonics or other syntax.
4474
4475 @table @code
4476 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4477 @cindex assembly instructions
4478 @cindex instructions, assembly
4479 @cindex machine instructions
4480 @cindex listing machine instructions
4481 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4482 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4483 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4484 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4485 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4486
4487 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4488 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4489 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4490 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4491 @end table
4492
4493
4494 @node Data
4495 @chapter Examining Data
4496
4497 @cindex printing data
4498 @cindex examining data
4499 @kindex print
4500 @kindex inspect
4501 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4502 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4503 @c different window or something like that.
4504 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4505 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4506 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4507 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4508 Different Languages}).
4509
4510 @table @code
4511 @item print @var{expr}
4512 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4513 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4514 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4515 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4516 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4517 formats}.
4518
4519 @item print
4520 @itemx print /@var{f}
4521 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4522 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4523 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4524 @end table
4525
4526 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4527 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4528 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4529
4530 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4531 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4532 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4533 Table}.
4534
4535 @menu
4536 * Expressions:: Expressions
4537 * Variables:: Program variables
4538 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4539 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4540 * Memory:: Examining memory
4541 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4542 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4543 * Value History:: Value history
4544 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4545 * Registers:: Registers
4546 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4547 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
4548 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4549 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
4550 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
4551 character set than GDB does
4552 @end menu
4553
4554 @node Expressions
4555 @section Expressions
4556
4557 @cindex expressions
4558 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4559 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4560 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4561 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
4562 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
4563 you compiled your program to include this information; see
4564 @ref{Compilation}.
4565
4566 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4567 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4568 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4569 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4570
4571 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4572 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4573 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4574 languages.
4575
4576 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4577 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4578
4579 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4580 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4581 at that address in memory.
4582 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4583
4584 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4585 to programming languages:
4586
4587 @table @code
4588 @item @@
4589 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4590 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4591
4592 @item ::
4593 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4594 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4595
4596 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4597 @cindex type casting memory
4598 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4599 @cindex casts, to view memory
4600 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4601 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4602 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4603 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4604 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4605 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4606 @end table
4607
4608 @node Variables
4609 @section Program variables
4610
4611 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4612 in your program.
4613
4614 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4615 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4616
4617 @itemize @bullet
4618 @item
4619 global (or file-static)
4620 @end itemize
4621
4622 @noindent or
4623
4624 @itemize @bullet
4625 @item
4626 visible according to the scope rules of the
4627 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4628 @end itemize
4629
4630 @noindent This means that in the function
4631
4632 @smallexample
4633 foo (a)
4634 int a;
4635 @{
4636 bar (a);
4637 @{
4638 int b = test ();
4639 bar (b);
4640 @}
4641 @}
4642 @end smallexample
4643
4644 @noindent
4645 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4646 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4647 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4648 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4649
4650 @cindex variable name conflict
4651 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4652 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4653 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4654 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4655 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4656 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4657 using the colon-colon notation:
4658
4659 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4660 @iftex
4661 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4662 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4663 @end iftex
4664 @smallexample
4665 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4666 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4667 @end smallexample
4668
4669 @noindent
4670 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4671 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4672 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4673 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4674
4675 @smallexample
4676 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4677 @end smallexample
4678
4679 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
4680 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4681 use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
4682 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4683 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4684 @c conflict?? --mew
4685
4686 @cindex wrong values
4687 @cindex variable values, wrong
4688 @quotation
4689 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4690 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4691 scope, and just before exit.
4692 @end quotation
4693 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4694 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4695 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4696 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4697 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4698 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4699 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4700 variable definitions may be gone.
4701
4702 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4703 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4704 when compiling.
4705
4706 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4707 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4708 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4709 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4710 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4711 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4712 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4713
4714 @smallexample
4715 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4716 @end smallexample
4717
4718 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4719 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4720 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler
4721 usually supports the @option{-gstabs+} option. @option{-gstabs+}
4722 produces debug info in a format that is superior to formats such as
4723 COFF. You may be able to use DWARF 2 (@option{-gdwarf-2}), which is also
4724 an effective form for debug info. @xref{Debugging Options,,Options
4725 for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
4726
4727
4728 @node Arrays
4729 @section Artificial arrays
4730
4731 @cindex artificial array
4732 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4733 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4734 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4735 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4736 program.
4737
4738 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4739 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4740 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4741 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4742 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4743 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4744 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4745 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4746 example. If a program says
4747
4748 @smallexample
4749 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4750 @end smallexample
4751
4752 @noindent
4753 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4754
4755 @smallexample
4756 p *array@@len
4757 @end smallexample
4758
4759 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4760 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4761 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4762 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4763 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4764
4765 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4766 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4767 The value need not be in memory:
4768 @smallexample
4769 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4770 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4771 @end smallexample
4772
4773 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4774 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4775 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4776 @smallexample
4777 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4778 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4779 @end smallexample
4780
4781 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4782 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4783 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4784 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4785 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4786 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4787 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4788 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4789 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4790 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4791
4792 @smallexample
4793 set $i = 0
4794 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4795 @key{RET}
4796 @key{RET}
4797 @dots{}
4798 @end smallexample
4799
4800 @node Output Formats
4801 @section Output formats
4802
4803 @cindex formatted output
4804 @cindex output formats
4805 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4806 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4807 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4808 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4809 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4810
4811 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4812 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4813 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4814 letters supported are:
4815
4816 @table @code
4817 @item x
4818 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4819 hexadecimal.
4820
4821 @item d
4822 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4823
4824 @item u
4825 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4826
4827 @item o
4828 Print as integer in octal.
4829
4830 @item t
4831 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4832 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4833 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4834 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4835
4836 @item a
4837 @cindex unknown address, locating
4838 @cindex locate address
4839 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4840 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4841 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4842
4843 @smallexample
4844 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4845 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4846 @end smallexample
4847
4848 @noindent
4849 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4850 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4851
4852 @item c
4853 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4854
4855 @item f
4856 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4857 using typical floating point syntax.
4858 @end table
4859
4860 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4861
4862 @smallexample
4863 p/x $pc
4864 @end smallexample
4865
4866 @noindent
4867 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4868 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4869
4870 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4871 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4872 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4873
4874 @node Memory
4875 @section Examining memory
4876
4877 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4878 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4879
4880 @cindex examining memory
4881 @table @code
4882 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4883 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4884 @itemx x @var{addr}
4885 @itemx x
4886 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4887 @end table
4888
4889 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4890 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4891 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4892 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4893 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4894
4895 @table @r
4896 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4897 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4898 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4899 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4900 @c 4.1.2.
4901
4902 @item @var{f}, the display format
4903 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4904 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4905 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4906 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4907
4908 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4909 The unit size is any of
4910
4911 @table @code
4912 @item b
4913 Bytes.
4914 @item h
4915 Halfwords (two bytes).
4916 @item w
4917 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4918 @item g
4919 Giant words (eight bytes).
4920 @end table
4921
4922 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4923 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4924 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4925
4926 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4927 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4928 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4929 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4930 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4931 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4932 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4933 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4934 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4935 a value from memory).
4936 @end table
4937
4938 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4939 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4940 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4941 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4942 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4943
4944 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4945 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4946 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4947 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4948 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4949
4950 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4951 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4952 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4953 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4954 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4955 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4956
4957 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4958 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4959 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4960 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4961 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4962 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4963 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4964
4965 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4966 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4967 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4968 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4969 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4970 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4971 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4972 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4973 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4974
4975 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4976 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4977 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4978
4979 @node Auto Display
4980 @section Automatic display
4981 @cindex automatic display
4982 @cindex display of expressions
4983
4984 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4985 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4986 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4987 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4988 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4989 The automatic display looks like this:
4990
4991 @smallexample
4992 2: foo = 38
4993 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4994 @end smallexample
4995
4996 @noindent
4997 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4998 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4999 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
5000 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
5001 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
5002 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
5003 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
5004
5005 @table @code
5006 @kindex display
5007 @item display @var{expr}
5008 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
5009 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5010
5011 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
5012
5013 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
5014 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
5015 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
5016 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
5017 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
5018
5019 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
5020 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
5021 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
5022 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
5023 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
5024 @end table
5025
5026 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
5027 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
5028 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5029
5030 @table @code
5031 @kindex delete display
5032 @kindex undisplay
5033 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
5034 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5035 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
5036
5037 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
5038 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
5039
5040 @kindex disable display
5041 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5042 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
5043 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
5044 enabled again later.
5045
5046 @kindex enable display
5047 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
5048 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
5049 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
5050
5051 @item display
5052 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
5053 done when your program stops.
5054
5055 @kindex info display
5056 @item info display
5057 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
5058 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
5059 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
5060 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
5061 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
5062 @end table
5063
5064 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
5065 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
5066 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
5067 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
5068 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
5069 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
5070 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
5071 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
5072 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
5073 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
5074
5075 @node Print Settings
5076 @section Print settings
5077
5078 @cindex format options
5079 @cindex print settings
5080 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
5081 and symbols are printed.
5082
5083 @noindent
5084 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
5085
5086 @table @code
5087 @kindex set print address
5088 @item set print address
5089 @itemx set print address on
5090 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
5091 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
5092 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
5093 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
5094 @code{set print address on}:
5095
5096 @smallexample
5097 @group
5098 (@value{GDBP}) f
5099 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
5100 at input.c:530
5101 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5102 @end group
5103 @end smallexample
5104
5105 @item set print address off
5106 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
5107 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
5108
5109 @smallexample
5110 @group
5111 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
5112 (@value{GDBP}) f
5113 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
5114 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
5115 @end group
5116 @end smallexample
5117
5118 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
5119 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
5120 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
5121 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
5122
5123 @kindex show print address
5124 @item show print address
5125 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
5126 @end table
5127
5128 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
5129 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
5130 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
5131 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
5132 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
5133 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
5134 it prints a symbolic address:
5135
5136 @table @code
5137 @kindex set print symbol-filename
5138 @item set print symbol-filename on
5139 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
5140 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5141
5142 @item set print symbol-filename off
5143 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
5144 default.
5145
5146 @kindex show print symbol-filename
5147 @item show print symbol-filename
5148 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5149 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5150 @end table
5151
5152 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5153 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5154 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5155
5156 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5157 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5158
5159 @table @code
5160 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5161 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5162 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5163 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5164 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
5165 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5166
5167 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5168 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
5169 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5170 symbolic address.
5171 @end table
5172
5173 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5174 @cindex pointer, finding referent
5175 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5176 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5177 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5178 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5179 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5180 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5181
5182 @smallexample
5183 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5184 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5185 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5186 @end smallexample
5187
5188 @quotation
5189 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5190 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5191 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5192 @end quotation
5193
5194 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5195
5196 @table @code
5197 @kindex set print array
5198 @item set print array
5199 @itemx set print array on
5200 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5201 but uses more space. The default is off.
5202
5203 @item set print array off
5204 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5205
5206 @kindex show print array
5207 @item show print array
5208 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5209 arrays.
5210
5211 @kindex set print elements
5212 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5213 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5214 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5215 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5216 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5217 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5218 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5219
5220 @kindex show print elements
5221 @item show print elements
5222 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5223 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5224
5225 @kindex set print null-stop
5226 @item set print null-stop
5227 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5228 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5229 contain only short strings.
5230 The default is off.
5231
5232 @kindex set print pretty
5233 @item set print pretty on
5234 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5235 per line, like this:
5236
5237 @smallexample
5238 @group
5239 $1 = @{
5240 next = 0x0,
5241 flags = @{
5242 sweet = 1,
5243 sour = 1
5244 @},
5245 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5246 @}
5247 @end group
5248 @end smallexample
5249
5250 @item set print pretty off
5251 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5252
5253 @smallexample
5254 @group
5255 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5256 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5257 @end group
5258 @end smallexample
5259
5260 @noindent
5261 This is the default format.
5262
5263 @kindex show print pretty
5264 @item show print pretty
5265 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5266
5267 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5268 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5269 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5270 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5271 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5272 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5273 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5274
5275 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5276 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5277 international character sets, and is the default.
5278
5279 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5280 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5281 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5282
5283 @kindex set print union
5284 @item set print union on
5285 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5286 is the default setting.
5287
5288 @item set print union off
5289 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5290
5291 @kindex show print union
5292 @item show print union
5293 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5294 structures.
5295
5296 For example, given the declarations
5297
5298 @smallexample
5299 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5300 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5301 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5302 Bug_forms;
5303
5304 struct thing @{
5305 Species it;
5306 union @{
5307 Tree_forms tree;
5308 Bug_forms bug;
5309 @} form;
5310 @};
5311
5312 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5313 @end smallexample
5314
5315 @noindent
5316 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5317
5318 @smallexample
5319 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5320 @end smallexample
5321
5322 @noindent
5323 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5324
5325 @smallexample
5326 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5327 @end smallexample
5328 @end table
5329
5330 @need 1000
5331 @noindent
5332 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
5333
5334 @table @code
5335 @cindex demangling
5336 @kindex set print demangle
5337 @item set print demangle
5338 @itemx set print demangle on
5339 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5340 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5341 linkage. The default is on.
5342
5343 @kindex show print demangle
5344 @item show print demangle
5345 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5346
5347 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5348 @item set print asm-demangle
5349 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5350 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5351 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5352 The default is off.
5353
5354 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5355 @item show print asm-demangle
5356 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5357 or demangled form.
5358
5359 @kindex set demangle-style
5360 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5361 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
5362 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5363 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5364 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5365
5366 @table @code
5367 @item auto
5368 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5369
5370 @item gnu
5371 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5372 This is the default.
5373
5374 @item hp
5375 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5376
5377 @item lucid
5378 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5379
5380 @item arm
5381 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
5382 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5383 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5384 require further enhancement to permit that.
5385
5386 @end table
5387 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5388
5389 @kindex show demangle-style
5390 @item show demangle-style
5391 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
5392
5393 @kindex set print object
5394 @item set print object
5395 @itemx set print object on
5396 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5397 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5398 the virtual function table.
5399
5400 @item set print object off
5401 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5402 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5403
5404 @kindex show print object
5405 @item show print object
5406 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5407
5408 @kindex set print static-members
5409 @item set print static-members
5410 @itemx set print static-members on
5411 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
5412
5413 @item set print static-members off
5414 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
5415
5416 @kindex show print static-members
5417 @item show print static-members
5418 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
5419
5420 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5421 @kindex set print vtbl
5422 @item set print vtbl
5423 @itemx set print vtbl on
5424 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
5425 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5426 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5427
5428 @item set print vtbl off
5429 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
5430
5431 @kindex show print vtbl
5432 @item show print vtbl
5433 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5434 @end table
5435
5436 @node Value History
5437 @section Value history
5438
5439 @cindex value history
5440 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5441 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5442 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5443 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5444 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5445 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5446 symbol table.
5447
5448 @cindex @code{$}
5449 @cindex @code{$$}
5450 @cindex history number
5451 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5452 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5453 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5454 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5455 history number.
5456
5457 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5458 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5459 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5460 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5461 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5462 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5463 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5464
5465 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5466 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5467
5468 @smallexample
5469 p *$
5470 @end smallexample
5471
5472 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5473 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5474
5475 @smallexample
5476 p *$.next
5477 @end smallexample
5478
5479 @noindent
5480 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5481 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5482
5483 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5484 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5485
5486 @smallexample
5487 print x
5488 set x=5
5489 @end smallexample
5490
5491 @noindent
5492 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5493 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5494
5495 @table @code
5496 @kindex show values
5497 @item show values
5498 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5499 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5500 values} does not change the history.
5501
5502 @item show values @var{n}
5503 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5504
5505 @item show values +
5506 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5507 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5508 @end table
5509
5510 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5511 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5512
5513 @node Convenience Vars
5514 @section Convenience variables
5515
5516 @cindex convenience variables
5517 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5518 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5519 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5520 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5521 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5522
5523 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5524 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5525 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5526 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5527 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5528
5529 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5530 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5531 For example:
5532
5533 @smallexample
5534 set $foo = *object_ptr
5535 @end smallexample
5536
5537 @noindent
5538 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5539 @code{object_ptr}.
5540
5541 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5542 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5543 value with another assignment at any time.
5544
5545 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5546 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5547 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5548 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5549
5550 @table @code
5551 @kindex show convenience
5552 @item show convenience
5553 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5554 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5555 @end table
5556
5557 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5558 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5559 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5560
5561 @smallexample
5562 set $i = 0
5563 print bar[$i++]->contents
5564 @end smallexample
5565
5566 @noindent
5567 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5568
5569 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5570 values likely to be useful.
5571
5572 @table @code
5573 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5574 @item $_
5575 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5576 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5577 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5578 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5579 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5580 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5581 to the type of @code{$__}.
5582
5583 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5584 @item $__
5585 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5586 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5587 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5588
5589 @item $_exitcode
5590 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5591 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5592 the program being debugged terminates.
5593 @end table
5594
5595 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5596 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5597 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5598
5599 @node Registers
5600 @section Registers
5601
5602 @cindex registers
5603 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5604 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5605 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5606 your machine.
5607
5608 @table @code
5609 @kindex info registers
5610 @item info registers
5611 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5612 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5613
5614 @kindex info all-registers
5615 @cindex floating point registers
5616 @item info all-registers
5617 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5618 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
5619
5620 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5621 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5622 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5623 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5624 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5625 @end table
5626
5627 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5628 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5629 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5630 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5631 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5632 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5633 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5634 you could print the program counter in hex with
5635
5636 @smallexample
5637 p/x $pc
5638 @end smallexample
5639
5640 @noindent
5641 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5642
5643 @smallexample
5644 x/i $pc
5645 @end smallexample
5646
5647 @noindent
5648 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5649 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5650 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5651 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5652 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5653 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5654 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5655
5656 @smallexample
5657 set $sp += 4
5658 @end smallexample
5659
5660 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5661 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5662 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5663 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5664 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5665 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5666 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5667
5668 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5669 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5670 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5671 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5672 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5673 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5674 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5675
5676 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5677 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5678 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5679 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5680 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5681 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5682 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5683 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5684 prints the data in both formats.
5685
5686 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5687 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5688 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5689 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5690 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5691 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5692
5693 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5694 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5695 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5696 frame makes no difference.
5697
5698 @node Floating Point Hardware
5699 @section Floating point hardware
5700 @cindex floating point
5701
5702 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5703 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5704
5705 @table @code
5706 @kindex info float
5707 @item info float
5708 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5709 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5710 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5711 the ARM and x86 machines.
5712 @end table
5713
5714 @node Vector Unit
5715 @section Vector Unit
5716 @cindex vector unit
5717
5718 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
5719 more information about the status of the vector unit.
5720
5721 @table @code
5722 @kindex info vector
5723 @item info vector
5724 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
5725 layout vary depending on the hardware.
5726 @end table
5727
5728 @node Memory Region Attributes
5729 @section Memory region attributes
5730 @cindex memory region attributes
5731
5732 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5733 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5734 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5735 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5736
5737 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5738 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5739 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5740 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5741 all memory.
5742
5743 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5744 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5745
5746 @table @code
5747 @kindex mem
5748 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5749 Define memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
5750 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a
5751 special case: it is treated as the the target's maximum memory address.
5752 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
5753
5754 @kindex delete mem
5755 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5756 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5757
5758 @kindex disable mem
5759 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5760 Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5761 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5762 It may be enabled again later.
5763
5764 @kindex enable mem
5765 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5766 Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
5767
5768 @kindex info mem
5769 @item info mem
5770 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5771 for each region.
5772
5773 @table @emph
5774 @item Memory Region Number
5775 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5776 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5777 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5778
5779 @item Lo Address
5780 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5781
5782 @item Hi Address
5783 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5784
5785 @item Attributes
5786 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5787 @end table
5788 @end table
5789
5790
5791 @subsection Attributes
5792
5793 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5794 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5795 write accesses to a memory region.
5796
5797 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5798 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5799 etc. from accessing memory.
5800
5801 @table @code
5802 @item ro
5803 Memory is read only.
5804 @item wo
5805 Memory is write only.
5806 @item rw
5807 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
5808 @end table
5809
5810 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5811 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5812 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5813 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5814 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5815
5816 @table @code
5817 @item 8
5818 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5819 @item 16
5820 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5821 @item 32
5822 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5823 @item 64
5824 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5825 @end table
5826
5827 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5828 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5829 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5830 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5831 @c
5832 @c @table @code
5833 @c @item hwbreak
5834 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5835 @c @item swbreak (default)
5836 @c @end table
5837
5838 @subsubsection Data Cache
5839 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5840 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5841 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5842 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5843 registers.
5844
5845 @table @code
5846 @item cache
5847 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5848 @item nocache
5849 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
5850 @end table
5851
5852 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5853 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5854 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5855 @c
5856 @c @table @code
5857 @c @item verify
5858 @c @item noverify (default)
5859 @c @end table
5860
5861 @node Dump/Restore Files
5862 @section Copy between memory and a file
5863 @cindex dump/restore files
5864 @cindex append data to a file
5865 @cindex dump data to a file
5866 @cindex restore data from a file
5867 @kindex dump
5868 @kindex append
5869 @kindex restore
5870
5871 The commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and @code{restore} are used
5872 for copying data between target memory and a file. Data is written
5873 into a file using @code{dump} or @code{append}, and restored from a
5874 file into memory by using @code{restore}. Files may be binary, srec,
5875 intel hex, or tekhex (but only binary files can be appended).
5876
5877 @table @code
5878 @kindex dump binary
5879 @kindex append binary
5880 @item dump binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5881 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5882 raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5883
5884 @item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5885 Append contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} to
5886 raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5887
5888 @item dump binary value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5889 Dump value of @var{expression} into raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5890
5891 @item append binary memory @var{filename} @var{expression}
5892 Append value of @var{expression} to raw binary format file @var{filename}.
5893
5894 @kindex dump ihex
5895 @item dump ihex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5896 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5897 intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5898
5899 @item dump ihex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5900 Dump value of @var{expression} into intel hex format file @var{filename}.
5901
5902 @kindex dump srec
5903 @item dump srec memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5904 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5905 srec format file @var{filename}.
5906
5907 @item dump srec value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5908 Dump value of @var{expression} into srec format file @var{filename}.
5909
5910 @kindex dump tekhex
5911 @item dump tekhex memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
5912 Dump contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr} into
5913 tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5914
5915 @item dump tekhex value @var{filename} @var{expression}
5916 Dump value of @var{expression} into tekhex format file @var{filename}.
5917
5918 @item restore @var{filename} [@var{binary}] @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
5919 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The @code{restore}
5920 command can automatically recognize any known bfd file format, except for
5921 raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you must use the optional argument
5922 @var{binary} after the filename.
5923
5924 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
5925 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
5926 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
5927 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
5928 from that location.
5929
5930 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
5931 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
5932 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
5933 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
5934
5935 @end table
5936
5937 @node Character Sets
5938 @section Character Sets
5939 @cindex character sets
5940 @cindex charset
5941 @cindex translating between character sets
5942 @cindex host character set
5943 @cindex target character set
5944
5945 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
5946 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
5947 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
5948 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
5949 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
5950 @dfn{target character set}.
5951
5952 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
5953 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
5954 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote,Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
5955 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
5956 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
5957 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
5958 target-charset ebcdic-us}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
5959 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
5960 character and string literals in expressions.
5961
5962 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
5963 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
5964 target-charset} command, described below.
5965
5966 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
5967 support:
5968
5969 @table @code
5970 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
5971 @kindex set target-charset
5972 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. We list the
5973 character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, but if you invoke the
5974 @code{set target-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists
5975 the character sets it supports.
5976 @end table
5977
5978 @table @code
5979 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
5980 @kindex set host-charset
5981 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
5982
5983 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
5984 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
5985 @code{set host-charset} command.
5986
5987 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
5988 set. We list the character set names @value{GDBN} recognizes below, and
5989 indicate which can be host character sets, but if you invoke the
5990 @code{set host-charset} command with no argument, @value{GDBN} lists the
5991 character sets it supports, placing an asterisk (@samp{*}) after those
5992 it can use as a host character set.
5993
5994 @item set charset @var{charset}
5995 @kindex set charset
5996 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. If you
5997 invoke the @code{set charset} command with no argument, it lists the
5998 character sets it supports. @value{GDBN} can only use certain character
5999 sets as its host character set; it marks those in the list with an
6000 asterisk (@samp{*}).
6001
6002 @item show charset
6003 @itemx show host-charset
6004 @itemx show target-charset
6005 @kindex show charset
6006 @kindex show host-charset
6007 @kindex show target-charset
6008 Show the current host and target charsets. The @code{show host-charset}
6009 and @code{show target-charset} commands are synonyms for @code{show
6010 charset}.
6011
6012 @end table
6013
6014 @value{GDBN} currently includes support for the following character
6015 sets:
6016
6017 @table @code
6018
6019 @item ASCII
6020 @cindex ASCII character set
6021 Seven-bit U.S. @sc{ascii}. @value{GDBN} can use this as its host
6022 character set.
6023
6024 @item ISO-8859-1
6025 @cindex ISO 8859-1 character set
6026 @cindex ISO Latin 1 character set
6027 The ISO Latin 1 character set. This extends ASCII with accented
6028 characters needed for French, German, and Spanish. @value{GDBN} can use
6029 this as its host character set.
6030
6031 @item EBCDIC-US
6032 @itemx IBM1047
6033 @cindex EBCDIC character set
6034 @cindex IBM1047 character set
6035 Variants of the @sc{ebcdic} character set, used on some of IBM's
6036 mainframe operating systems. (@sc{gnu}/Linux on the S/390 uses U.S. @sc{ascii}.)
6037 @value{GDBN} cannot use these as its host character set.
6038
6039 @end table
6040
6041 Note that these are all single-byte character sets. More work inside
6042 GDB is needed to support multi-byte or variable-width character
6043 encodings, like the UTF-8 and UCS-2 encodings of Unicode.
6044
6045 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
6046 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
6047 @file{charset-test.c}:
6048
6049 @smallexample
6050 #include <stdio.h>
6051
6052 char ascii_hello[]
6053 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
6054 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
6055 char ibm1047_hello[]
6056 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
6057 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
6058
6059 main ()
6060 @{
6061 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6062 @}
6063 @end smallexample
6064
6065 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
6066 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
6067 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
6068
6069 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
6070
6071 @smallexample
6072 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
6073 $ gdb -nw charset-test
6074 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
6075 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6076 @dots{}
6077 (gdb)
6078 @end smallexample
6079
6080 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
6081 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
6082 strings:
6083
6084 @smallexample
6085 (gdb) show charset
6086 The current host and target character set is `iso-8859-1'.
6087 (gdb)
6088 @end smallexample
6089
6090 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
6091 initial character set:
6092 @smallexample
6093 (gdb) set charset ascii
6094 (gdb) show charset
6095 The current host and target character set is `ascii'.
6096 (gdb)
6097 @end smallexample
6098
6099 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
6100 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
6101 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
6102 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
6103 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
6104
6105 @smallexample
6106 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6107 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
6108 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6109 $2 = 72 'H'
6110 (gdb)
6111 @end smallexample
6112
6113 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
6114 literals you use in expressions:
6115
6116 @smallexample
6117 (gdb) print '+'
6118 $3 = 43 '+'
6119 (gdb)
6120 @end smallexample
6121
6122 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
6123 character.
6124
6125 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
6126 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
6127 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
6128
6129 @smallexample
6130 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6131 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
6132 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6133 $5 = 200 '\310'
6134 (gdb)
6135 @end smallexample
6136
6137 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} command without an argument,
6138 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
6139
6140 @smallexample
6141 (gdb) set target-charset
6142 Valid character sets are:
6143 ascii *
6144 iso-8859-1 *
6145 ebcdic-us
6146 ibm1047
6147 * - can be used as a host character set
6148 @end smallexample
6149
6150 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
6151 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
6152 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
6153 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
6154 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
6155
6156 @smallexample
6157 (gdb) set target-charset ibm1047
6158 (gdb) show charset
6159 The current host character set is `ascii'.
6160 The current target character set is `ibm1047'.
6161 (gdb) print ascii_hello
6162 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
6163 (gdb) print ascii_hello[0]
6164 $7 = 72 '\110'
6165 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello
6166 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
6167 (gdb) print ibm1047_hello[0]
6168 $9 = 200 'H'
6169 (gdb)
6170 @end smallexample
6171
6172 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
6173 string literals you use in expressions:
6174
6175 @smallexample
6176 (gdb) print '+'
6177 $10 = 78 '+'
6178 (gdb)
6179 @end smallexample
6180
6181 The IBM1047 character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
6182 character.
6183
6184
6185 @node Macros
6186 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
6187
6188 Some languages, such as C and C++, provide a way to define and invoke
6189 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
6190 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
6191 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
6192 where it was defined.
6193
6194 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
6195 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
6196 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
6197 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
6198
6199 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
6200 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
6201 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
6202 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
6203 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
6204 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
6205 see @ref{List}.
6206
6207 At the moment, @value{GDBN} does not support the @code{##}
6208 token-splicing operator, the @code{#} stringification operator, or
6209 variable-arity macros.
6210
6211 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
6212 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
6213 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
6214
6215 @table @code
6216
6217 @kindex macro expand
6218 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
6219 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
6220 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
6221 @item macro expand @var{expression}
6222 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
6223 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
6224 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
6225 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
6226 it can be any string of tokens.
6227
6228 @kindex macro expand-once
6229 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
6230 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
6231 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
6232 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
6233 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
6234 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
6235 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
6236 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
6237 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
6238 can be any string of tokens.
6239
6240 @kindex info macro
6241 @cindex macro definition, showing
6242 @cindex definition, showing a macro's
6243 @item info macro @var{macro}
6244 Show the definition of the macro named @var{macro}, and describe the
6245 source location where that definition was established.
6246
6247 @kindex macro define
6248 @cindex user-defined macros
6249 @cindex defining macros interactively
6250 @cindex macros, user-defined
6251 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
6252 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
6253 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Introduce a definition for a
6254 preprocessor macro named @var{macro}, invocations of which are replaced
6255 by the tokens given in @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this
6256 command defines an ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the
6257 second form defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments
6258 given in @var{arglist}.
6259
6260 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every expression
6261 evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the @command{macro
6262 undef} command, described below. The definition overrides all
6263 definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged, as
6264 well as any previous user-supplied definition.
6265
6266 @kindex macro undef
6267 @item macro undef @var{macro}
6268 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Remove any user-supplied
6269 definition for the macro named @var{macro}. This command only affects
6270 definitions provided with the @command{macro define} command, described
6271 above; it cannot remove definitions present in the program being
6272 debugged.
6273
6274 @end table
6275
6276 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
6277 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
6278 show our source files:
6279
6280 @smallexample
6281 $ cat sample.c
6282 #include <stdio.h>
6283 #include "sample.h"
6284
6285 #define M 42
6286 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6287
6288 main ()
6289 @{
6290 #define N 28
6291 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6292 #undef N
6293 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6294 #define N 1729
6295 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6296 @}
6297 $ cat sample.h
6298 #define Q <
6299 $
6300 @end smallexample
6301
6302 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler, @value{NGCC}.
6303 We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-g3} flags to ensure the
6304 compiler includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
6305 information.
6306
6307 @smallexample
6308 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
6309 $
6310 @end smallexample
6311
6312 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
6313
6314 @smallexample
6315 $ gdb -nw sample
6316 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
6317 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6318 GDB is free software, @dots{}
6319 (gdb)
6320 @end smallexample
6321
6322 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
6323 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
6324 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
6325
6326 @smallexample
6327 (gdb) list main
6328 3
6329 4 #define M 42
6330 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6331 6
6332 7 main ()
6333 8 @{
6334 9 #define N 28
6335 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6336 11 #undef N
6337 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6338 (gdb) info macro ADD
6339 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
6340 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
6341 (gdb) info macro Q
6342 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
6343 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
6344 #define Q <
6345 (gdb) macro expand ADD(1)
6346 expands to: (42 + 1)
6347 (gdb) macro expand-once ADD(1)
6348 expands to: once (M + 1)
6349 (gdb)
6350 @end smallexample
6351
6352 In the example above, note that @command{macro expand-once} expands only
6353 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
6354 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
6355 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
6356
6357 Once the program is running, GDB uses the macro definitions in force at
6358 the source line of the current stack frame:
6359
6360 @smallexample
6361 (gdb) break main
6362 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
6363 (gdb) run
6364 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
6365
6366 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
6367 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
6368 (gdb)
6369 @end smallexample
6370
6371 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
6372
6373 @smallexample
6374 (gdb) info macro N
6375 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
6376 #define N 28
6377 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6378 expands to: 28 < 42
6379 (gdb) print N Q M
6380 $1 = 1
6381 (gdb)
6382 @end smallexample
6383
6384 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
6385 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
6386 thereof) in force at each point:
6387
6388 @smallexample
6389 (gdb) next
6390 Hello, world!
6391 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
6392 (gdb) info macro N
6393 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
6394 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
6395 (gdb) next
6396 We're so creative.
6397 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
6398 (gdb) info macro N
6399 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
6400 #define N 1729
6401 (gdb) macro expand N Q M
6402 expands to: 1729 < 42
6403 (gdb) print N Q M
6404 $2 = 0
6405 (gdb)
6406 @end smallexample
6407
6408
6409 @node Tracepoints
6410 @chapter Tracepoints
6411 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
6412 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
6413
6414 @cindex tracepoints
6415 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
6416 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
6417 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
6418 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
6419 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
6420 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
6421 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
6422
6423 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
6424 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
6425 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
6426 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
6427 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
6428 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
6429 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
6430 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
6431 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
6432 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
6433 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
6434
6435 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
6436 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
6437 to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
6438 stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
6439 tracepoints as of this writing.
6440
6441 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
6442
6443 @menu
6444 * Set Tracepoints::
6445 * Analyze Collected Data::
6446 * Tracepoint Variables::
6447 @end menu
6448
6449 @node Set Tracepoints
6450 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
6451
6452 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
6453 tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
6454 tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
6455 breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
6456 one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
6457 tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
6458 work on.
6459
6460 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
6461 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
6462 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
6463 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
6464 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
6465 tracepoint was hit.
6466
6467 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
6468 conditions and actions.
6469
6470 @menu
6471 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
6472 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
6473 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
6474 * Tracepoint Actions::
6475 * Listing Tracepoints::
6476 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
6477 @end menu
6478
6479 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
6480 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
6481
6482 @table @code
6483 @cindex set tracepoint
6484 @kindex trace
6485 @item trace
6486 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
6487 Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
6488 the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
6489 defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
6490 debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
6491 program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
6492 doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
6493 cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
6494 running.
6495
6496 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
6497
6498 @smallexample
6499 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
6500
6501 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
6502
6503 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
6504
6505 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
6506
6507 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
6508 @end smallexample
6509
6510 @noindent
6511 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
6512
6513 @vindex $tpnum
6514 @cindex last tracepoint number
6515 @cindex recent tracepoint number
6516 @cindex tracepoint number
6517 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
6518 of the most recently set tracepoint.
6519
6520 @kindex delete tracepoint
6521 @cindex tracepoint deletion
6522 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6523 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
6524 default is to delete all tracepoints.
6525
6526 Examples:
6527
6528 @smallexample
6529 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
6530
6531 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
6532 @end smallexample
6533
6534 @noindent
6535 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
6536 @end table
6537
6538 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6539 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
6540
6541 @table @code
6542 @kindex disable tracepoint
6543 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6544 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
6545 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
6546 the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
6547 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
6548
6549 @kindex enable tracepoint
6550 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6551 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
6552 tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
6553 run.
6554 @end table
6555
6556 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
6557 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
6558
6559 @table @code
6560 @kindex passcount
6561 @cindex tracepoint pass count
6562 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
6563 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
6564 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
6565 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
6566 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
6567 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
6568 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
6569 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
6570 user.
6571
6572 Examples:
6573
6574 @smallexample
6575 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
6576 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
6577
6578 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6579 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
6580 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
6582 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
6583 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
6584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
6585 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6586 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
6587 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
6588 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
6589 @end smallexample
6590 @end table
6591
6592 @node Tracepoint Actions
6593 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
6594
6595 @table @code
6596 @kindex actions
6597 @cindex tracepoint actions
6598 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6599 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
6600 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
6601 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
6602 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
6603 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
6604 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
6605 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
6606 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
6607 @code{while-stepping}.
6608
6609 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
6610 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
6611 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
6612
6613 @smallexample
6614 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
6615
6616 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
6617
6618 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
6619 @end smallexample
6620
6621 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
6622 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
6623 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
6624 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
6625 followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
6626 @code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
6627 @code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
6628 @code{end} command.
6629
6630 @smallexample
6631 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
6632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6633 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
6634 > collect bar,baz
6635 > collect $regs
6636 > while-stepping 12
6637 > collect $fp, $sp
6638 > end
6639 end
6640 @end smallexample
6641
6642 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
6643 @item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
6644 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
6645 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
6646 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
6647 special arguments are supported:
6648
6649 @table @code
6650 @item $regs
6651 collect all registers
6652
6653 @item $args
6654 collect all function arguments
6655
6656 @item $locals
6657 collect all local variables.
6658 @end table
6659
6660 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
6661 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
6662 arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
6663
6664 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
6665 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
6666
6667 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
6668 @item while-stepping @var{n}
6669 Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
6670 new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
6671 followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
6672 its own @code{end} command):
6673
6674 @smallexample
6675 > while-stepping 12
6676 > collect $regs, myglobal
6677 > end
6678 >
6679 @end smallexample
6680
6681 @noindent
6682 You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
6683 @code{stepping}.
6684 @end table
6685
6686 @node Listing Tracepoints
6687 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
6688
6689 @table @code
6690 @kindex info tracepoints
6691 @cindex information about tracepoints
6692 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
6693 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
6694 a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
6695 defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
6696 shown:
6697
6698 @itemize @bullet
6699 @item
6700 its number
6701 @item
6702 whether it is enabled or disabled
6703 @item
6704 its address
6705 @item
6706 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
6707 @item
6708 its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
6709 @item
6710 where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6711 @item
6712 its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6713 @end itemize
6714
6715 @smallexample
6716 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6717 Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
6718 1 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6719 2 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
6720 3 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
6721 (@value{GDBP})
6722 @end smallexample
6723
6724 @noindent
6725 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6726 @end table
6727
6728 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6729 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6730
6731 @table @code
6732 @kindex tstart
6733 @cindex start a new trace experiment
6734 @cindex collected data discarded
6735 @item tstart
6736 This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6737 begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6738 the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6739 experiment.
6740
6741 @kindex tstop
6742 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
6743 @item tstop
6744 This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6745 stops collecting data.
6746
6747 @strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6748 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6749 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6750
6751 @kindex tstatus
6752 @cindex status of trace data collection
6753 @cindex trace experiment, status of
6754 @item tstatus
6755 This command displays the status of the current trace data
6756 collection.
6757 @end table
6758
6759 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6760
6761 @smallexample
6762 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6763 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6764 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6765 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
6766 > while-stepping 11
6767 > collect $regs
6768 > end
6769 > end
6770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6771 [time passes @dots{}]
6772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6773 @end smallexample
6774
6775
6776 @node Analyze Collected Data
6777 @section Using the collected data
6778
6779 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6780 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6781 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6782 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6783 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6784 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6785 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6786 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6787 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6788 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6789 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6790 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6791 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6792 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6793 the buffer will fail.
6794
6795 @menu
6796 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6797 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6798 * save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6799 @end menu
6800
6801 @node tfind
6802 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6803
6804 @kindex tfind
6805 @cindex select trace snapshot
6806 @cindex find trace snapshot
6807 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6808 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6809 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6810 snapshot is selected.
6811
6812 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6813
6814 @table @code
6815 @item tfind start
6816 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6817 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6818
6819 @item tfind none
6820 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6821
6822 @item tfind end
6823 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6824
6825 @item tfind
6826 No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6827
6828 @item tfind -
6829 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6830 retracing earlier steps.
6831
6832 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6833 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6834 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6835 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6836 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6837
6838 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
6839 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6840 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6841 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6842 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6843
6844 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6845 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6846 addresses.
6847
6848 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6849 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6850 @var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6851
6852 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6853 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6854 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6855 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6856 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6857 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6858 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6859 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6860 @end table
6861
6862 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6863 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6864 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6865 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6866 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6867 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6868 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6869 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6870 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6871 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6872 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6873 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6874 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6875 tracepoint as the current one.
6876
6877 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6878 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6879 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6880 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6881 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6882
6883 @smallexample
6884 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6885 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6886 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6887 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6888 > tfind
6889 > end
6890
6891 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6892 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6893 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6894 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6895 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6896 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6897 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6898 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6899 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6900 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6901 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6902 @end smallexample
6903
6904 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6905 the buffer:
6906
6907 @smallexample
6908 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6909 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6910 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6911 > tfind line
6912 > end
6913
6914 Frame 0, X = 1
6915 Frame 7, X = 2
6916 Frame 13, X = 255
6917 @end smallexample
6918
6919 @node tdump
6920 @subsection @code{tdump}
6921 @kindex tdump
6922 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6923 @cindex tracepoint data, display
6924
6925 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6926 the current trace snapshot.
6927
6928 @smallexample
6929 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6930 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6931 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6932 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6933 > end
6934
6935 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6936
6937 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6938 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6939 at gdb_test.c:444
6940 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6941
6942 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6943 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6944 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6945 d1 0x18 24
6946 d2 0x80 128
6947 d3 0x33 51
6948 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6949 d5 0x22 34
6950 d6 0xe0 224
6951 d7 0x380035 3670069
6952 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6953 a1 0x3000668 50333288
6954 a2 0x100 256
6955 a3 0x322000 3284992
6956 a4 0x3000698 50333336
6957 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6958 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6959 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6960 ps 0x0 0
6961 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6962 fpcontrol 0x0 0
6963 fpstatus 0x0 0
6964 fpiaddr 0x0 0
6965 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6966 p1 = (void *) 0x11
6967 p2 = (void *) 0x22
6968 p3 = (void *) 0x33
6969 p4 = (void *) 0x44
6970 p5 = (void *) 0x55
6971 p6 = (void *) 0x66
6972 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6973
6974 (@value{GDBP})
6975 @end smallexample
6976
6977 @node save-tracepoints
6978 @subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6979 @kindex save-tracepoints
6980 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6981
6982 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6983 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6984 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6985 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6986 Files}).
6987
6988 @node Tracepoint Variables
6989 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6990 @cindex tracepoint variables
6991 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6992
6993 @table @code
6994 @vindex $trace_frame
6995 @item (int) $trace_frame
6996 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6997 snapshot is selected.
6998
6999 @vindex $tracepoint
7000 @item (int) $tracepoint
7001 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
7002
7003 @vindex $trace_line
7004 @item (int) $trace_line
7005 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
7006
7007 @vindex $trace_file
7008 @item (char []) $trace_file
7009 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
7010
7011 @vindex $trace_func
7012 @item (char []) $trace_func
7013 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
7014 @end table
7015
7016 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
7017 use @code{output} instead.
7018
7019 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
7020 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
7021 data.
7022
7023 @smallexample
7024 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
7025
7026 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
7027 > output $trace_file
7028 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
7029 > tfind
7030 > end
7031 @end smallexample
7032
7033 @node Overlays
7034 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
7035 @cindex overlays
7036
7037 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
7038 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
7039 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
7040 use overlays.
7041
7042 @menu
7043 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
7044 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
7045 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
7046 mapped by asking the inferior.
7047 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
7048 @end menu
7049
7050 @node How Overlays Work
7051 @section How Overlays Work
7052 @cindex mapped overlays
7053 @cindex unmapped overlays
7054 @cindex load address, overlay's
7055 @cindex mapped address
7056 @cindex overlay area
7057
7058 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
7059 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
7060 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
7061 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
7062 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
7063
7064 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
7065 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
7066 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
7067 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
7068 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
7069 largest overlay as well.
7070
7071 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
7072 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
7073 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
7074 there.
7075
7076 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
7077 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
7078 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
7079
7080 @smallexample
7081 @group
7082 Data Instruction Larger
7083 Address Space Address Space Address Space
7084 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
7085 | | | | | |
7086 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
7087 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
7088 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
7089 | and heap | | | | | |
7090 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
7091 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
7092 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
7093 | | | | | |
7094 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
7095 address | | | | | |
7096 | overlay | <-' | | |
7097 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
7098 | | <---. | | load address
7099 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
7100 | | | |
7101 +-----------+ | |
7102 +-----------+
7103 | |
7104 +-----------+
7105
7106 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
7107 @end group
7108 @end smallexample
7109
7110 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
7111 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
7112 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
7113 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
7114 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
7115 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
7116 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
7117 program and the overlay area.
7118
7119 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
7120 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
7121 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
7122 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
7123 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
7124 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
7125 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
7126
7127 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
7128 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
7129 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
7130
7131 @itemize @bullet
7132
7133 @item
7134 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
7135 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
7136 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
7137 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
7138
7139 @item
7140 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
7141 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
7142 your program's performance.
7143
7144 @item
7145 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
7146 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
7147 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
7148 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
7149 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
7150 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
7151 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
7152
7153 @item
7154 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
7155 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
7156 instruction and data spaces.
7157
7158 @end itemize
7159
7160 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
7161 improved in many ways:
7162
7163 @itemize @bullet
7164
7165 @item
7166 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
7167 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
7168 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
7169 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
7170 area in the usual way.
7171
7172 @item
7173 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
7174 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
7175
7176 @item
7177 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
7178 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
7179 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
7180 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
7181 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
7182 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
7183 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
7184
7185 @end itemize
7186
7187
7188 @node Overlay Commands
7189 @section Overlay Commands
7190
7191 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
7192 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
7193 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
7194 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
7195 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
7196 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
7197
7198 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
7199 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
7200
7201 @table @code
7202 @item overlay off
7203 @kindex overlay off
7204 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
7205 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
7206 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
7207 overlay support is disabled.
7208
7209 @item overlay manual
7210 @kindex overlay manual
7211 @cindex manual overlay debugging
7212 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7213 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
7214 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
7215 commands described below.
7216
7217 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
7218 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
7219 @kindex overlay map-overlay
7220 @cindex map an overlay
7221 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
7222 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
7223 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
7224 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
7225 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
7226 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
7227
7228 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
7229 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
7230 @kindex overlay unmap-overlay
7231 @cindex unmap an overlay
7232 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
7233 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
7234 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
7235 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
7236
7237 @item overlay auto
7238 @kindex overlay auto
7239 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
7240 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
7241 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
7242 Overlay Debugging}.
7243
7244 @item overlay load-target
7245 @itemx overlay load
7246 @kindex overlay load-target
7247 @cindex reloading the overlay table
7248 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
7249 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
7250 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
7251 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
7252 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
7253
7254 @item overlay list-overlays
7255 @itemx overlay list
7256 @cindex listing mapped overlays
7257 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
7258 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
7259
7260 @end table
7261
7262 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
7263 of the function the address falls in:
7264
7265 @smallexample
7266 (gdb) print main
7267 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
7268 @end smallexample
7269 @noindent
7270 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
7271 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
7272 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
7273 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
7274
7275 @smallexample
7276 (gdb) overlay list
7277 No sections are mapped.
7278 (gdb) print foo
7279 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
7280 @end smallexample
7281 @noindent
7282 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
7283 name normally:
7284
7285 @smallexample
7286 (gdb) overlay list
7287 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
7288 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
7289 (gdb) print foo
7290 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
7291 @end smallexample
7292
7293 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
7294 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
7295 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
7296 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
7297 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
7298
7299 @itemize @bullet
7300 @item
7301 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
7302 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
7303 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
7304 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
7305 @item
7306 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
7307 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
7308 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
7309 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
7310 breakpoints properly.
7311 @end itemize
7312
7313
7314 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
7315 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
7316 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
7317
7318 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
7319 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
7320 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
7321 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
7322 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
7323 current state of the overlays.
7324
7325 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
7326 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
7327
7328 @table @asis
7329
7330 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
7331 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
7332
7333 @smallexample
7334 struct
7335 @{
7336 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
7337 unsigned long vma;
7338
7339 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
7340 unsigned long size;
7341
7342 /* The overlay's load address. */
7343 unsigned long lma;
7344
7345 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
7346 zero otherwise. */
7347 unsigned long mapped;
7348 @}
7349 @end smallexample
7350
7351 @item @code{_novlys}:
7352 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
7353 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
7354
7355 @end table
7356
7357 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
7358 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
7359 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
7360 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
7361 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
7362 currently mapped.
7363
7364 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
7365 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
7366 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
7367 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
7368 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
7369 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
7370 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
7371 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
7372 are not being executed.
7373
7374 @node Overlay Sample Program
7375 @section Overlay Sample Program
7376 @cindex overlay example program
7377
7378 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
7379 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
7380 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
7381 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
7382 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
7383 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
7384 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
7385
7386 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
7387 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
7388 suite. The program consists of the following files from
7389 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
7390
7391 @table @file
7392 @item overlays.c
7393 The main program file.
7394 @item ovlymgr.c
7395 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
7396 @item foo.c
7397 @itemx bar.c
7398 @itemx baz.c
7399 @itemx grbx.c
7400 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
7401 @item d10v.ld
7402 @itemx m32r.ld
7403 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
7404 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
7405 @end table
7406
7407 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
7408 cross-compiler like this:
7409
7410 @smallexample
7411 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
7412 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
7413 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
7414 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
7415 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
7416 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
7417 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
7418 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
7419 @end smallexample
7420
7421 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
7422 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
7423 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
7424
7425
7426 @node Languages
7427 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
7428 @cindex languages
7429
7430 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
7431 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
7432 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
7433 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
7434 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
7435 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
7436
7437 @cindex working language
7438 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
7439 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
7440 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
7441 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
7442 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
7443 language}.
7444
7445 @menu
7446 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
7447 * Show:: Displaying the language
7448 * Checks:: Type and range checks
7449 * Support:: Supported languages
7450 @end menu
7451
7452 @node Setting
7453 @section Switching between source languages
7454
7455 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
7456 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
7457 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
7458 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
7459 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
7460 are printed, etc.
7461
7462 In addition to the working language, every source file that
7463 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
7464 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
7465 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
7466 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
7467 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
7468 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
7469 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
7470 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
7471 Displaying the language}.
7472
7473 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
7474 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
7475 another language. In that case, make the
7476 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
7477 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
7478 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
7479
7480 @menu
7481 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
7482 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
7483 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7484 @end menu
7485
7486 @node Filenames
7487 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
7488
7489 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
7490 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
7491
7492 @table @file
7493
7494 @item .c
7495 C source file
7496
7497 @item .C
7498 @itemx .cc
7499 @itemx .cp
7500 @itemx .cpp
7501 @itemx .cxx
7502 @itemx .c++
7503 C@t{++} source file
7504
7505 @item .f
7506 @itemx .F
7507 Fortran source file
7508
7509 @item .mod
7510 Modula-2 source file
7511
7512 @item .s
7513 @itemx .S
7514 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
7515 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
7516 @end table
7517
7518 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
7519 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
7520
7521 @node Manually
7522 @subsection Setting the working language
7523
7524 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
7525 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
7526 your program.
7527
7528 @kindex set language
7529 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
7530 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
7531 a language, such as
7532 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
7533 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
7534
7535 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
7536 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
7537 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
7538 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
7539 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
7540 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
7541 command such as:
7542
7543 @smallexample
7544 print a = b + c
7545 @end smallexample
7546
7547 @noindent
7548 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
7549 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
7550 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
7551 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
7552
7553 @node Automatically
7554 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
7555
7556 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
7557 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
7558 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
7559 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
7560 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
7561 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
7562 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
7563 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
7564 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
7565
7566 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
7567 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
7568 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
7569 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
7570 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
7571
7572 @node Show
7573 @section Displaying the language
7574
7575 The following commands help you find out which language is the
7576 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
7577
7578 @kindex show language
7579 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
7580 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
7581 @table @code
7582 @item show language
7583 Display the current working language. This is the
7584 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
7585 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
7586
7587 @item info frame
7588 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
7589 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
7590 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
7591 information listed here.
7592
7593 @item info source
7594 Display the source language of this source file.
7595 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
7596 information listed here.
7597 @end table
7598
7599 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
7600 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
7601 with a language explicitly:
7602
7603 @kindex set extension-language
7604 @kindex info extensions
7605 @table @code
7606 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
7607 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
7608 the source language @var{language}.
7609
7610 @item info extensions
7611 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
7612 @end table
7613
7614 @node Checks
7615 @section Type and range checking
7616
7617 @quotation
7618 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
7619 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
7620 section documents the intended facilities.
7621 @end quotation
7622 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
7623
7624 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
7625 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
7626 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
7627 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
7628 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
7629 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
7630 errors when your program is running.
7631
7632 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
7633 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
7634 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
7635 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
7636 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
7637 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
7638 for the default settings of supported languages.
7639
7640 @menu
7641 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
7642 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
7643 @end menu
7644
7645 @cindex type checking
7646 @cindex checks, type
7647 @node Type Checking
7648 @subsection An overview of type checking
7649
7650 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
7651 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
7652 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
7653 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
7654
7655 @smallexample
7656 1 + 2 @result{} 3
7657 @exdent but
7658 @error{} 1 + 2.3
7659 @end smallexample
7660
7661 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
7662 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
7663
7664 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
7665 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
7666 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
7667 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
7668 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
7669 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
7670 also issues a warning.
7671
7672 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
7673 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
7674 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
7675 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
7676 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
7677 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
7678
7679 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
7680 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
7681 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
7682 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
7683 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
7684 details on specific languages.
7685
7686 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
7687
7688 @kindex set check@r{, type}
7689 @kindex set check type
7690 @kindex show check type
7691 @table @code
7692 @item set check type auto
7693 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
7694 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7695 each language.
7696
7697 @item set check type on
7698 @itemx set check type off
7699 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7700 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
7701 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
7702 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
7703 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
7704
7705 @item set check type warn
7706 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
7707 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
7708 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
7709 numbers and structures.
7710
7711 @item show type
7712 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
7713 is setting it automatically.
7714 @end table
7715
7716 @cindex range checking
7717 @cindex checks, range
7718 @node Range Checking
7719 @subsection An overview of range checking
7720
7721 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7722 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7723 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7724 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7725 not exceed the bounds of the array.
7726
7727 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7728 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7729 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7730 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7731
7732 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7733 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7734 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7735 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7736 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7737 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7738
7739 @smallexample
7740 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7741 @end smallexample
7742
7743 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7744 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7745 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7746
7747 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7748
7749 @kindex set check@r{, range}
7750 @kindex set check range
7751 @kindex show check range
7752 @table @code
7753 @item set check range auto
7754 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7755 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7756 each language.
7757
7758 @item set check range on
7759 @itemx set check range off
7760 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7761 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
7762 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7763 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
7764
7765 @item set check range warn
7766 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7767 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7768 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7769 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7770 systems).
7771
7772 @item show range
7773 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7774 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7775 @end table
7776
7777 @node Support
7778 @section Supported languages
7779
7780 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, assembly, and Modula-2.
7781 @c This is false ...
7782 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7783 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7784 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7785 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7786 language.
7787
7788 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7789 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7790 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7791 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7792 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7793 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7794 language reference or tutorial.
7795
7796 @menu
7797 * C:: C and C@t{++}
7798 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
7799 @end menu
7800
7801 @node C
7802 @subsection C and C@t{++}
7803
7804 @cindex C and C@t{++}
7805 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
7806
7807 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
7808 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7809 together.
7810
7811 @cindex C@t{++}
7812 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
7813 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7814 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7815 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7816 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7817 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
7818 compiler (@code{aCC}).
7819
7820 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the DWARF 2 debugging
7821 format; if it doesn't work on your system, try the stabs+ debugging
7822 format. You can select those formats explicitly with the @code{g++}
7823 command-line options @option{-gdwarf-2} and @option{-gstabs+}.
7824 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7825 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}.
7826
7827 @menu
7828 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7829 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7830 * C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7831 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7832 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7833 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
7834 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
7835 @end menu
7836
7837 @node C Operators
7838 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7839
7840 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
7841
7842 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7843 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7844 often defined on groups of types.
7845
7846 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
7847
7848 @itemize @bullet
7849
7850 @item
7851 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
7852 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
7853
7854 @item
7855 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7856 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
7857
7858 @item
7859 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
7860
7861 @item
7862 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
7863
7864 @end itemize
7865
7866 @noindent
7867 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7868 in order of increasing precedence:
7869
7870 @table @code
7871 @item ,
7872 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7873 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7874 expression being the last expression evaluated.
7875
7876 @item =
7877 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7878 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7879
7880 @item @var{op}=
7881 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7882 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
7883 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
7884 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7885 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7886
7887 @item ?:
7888 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7889 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7890 integral type.
7891
7892 @item ||
7893 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7894
7895 @item &&
7896 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7897
7898 @item |
7899 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7900
7901 @item ^
7902 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7903
7904 @item &
7905 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7906
7907 @item ==@r{, }!=
7908 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7909 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7910
7911 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7912 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7913 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7914 and non-zero for true.
7915
7916 @item <<@r{, }>>
7917 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7918
7919 @item @@
7920 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7921
7922 @item +@r{, }-
7923 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7924 pointer types.
7925
7926 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7927 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7928 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7929 integral types.
7930
7931 @item ++@r{, }--
7932 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7933 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7934 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7935 operation takes place.
7936
7937 @item *
7938 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7939 @code{++}.
7940
7941 @item &
7942 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7943
7944 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7945 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
7946 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
7947 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
7948 stored.
7949
7950 @item -
7951 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7952 precedence as @code{++}.
7953
7954 @item !
7955 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7956 @code{++}.
7957
7958 @item ~
7959 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7960 @code{++}.
7961
7962
7963 @item .@r{, }->
7964 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7965 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7966 pointer based on the stored type information.
7967 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7968
7969 @item .*@r{, }->*
7970 Dereferences of pointers to members.
7971
7972 @item []
7973 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7974 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7975
7976 @item ()
7977 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7978
7979 @item ::
7980 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7981 and @code{class} types.
7982
7983 @item ::
7984 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7985 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7986 above.
7987 @end table
7988
7989 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7990 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7991 predefined meaning.
7992
7993 @menu
7994 * C Constants::
7995 @end menu
7996
7997 @node C Constants
7998 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
7999
8000 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
8001
8002 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
8003 following ways:
8004
8005 @itemize @bullet
8006 @item
8007 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
8008 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
8009 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
8010 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
8011 @code{long} value.
8012
8013 @item
8014 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
8015 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
8016 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
8017 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
8018 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
8019 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
8020 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
8021 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
8022 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
8023 constant.
8024
8025 @item
8026 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
8027 integral equivalents.
8028
8029 @item
8030 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
8031 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
8032 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
8033 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
8034 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
8035 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
8036 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
8037 @samp{\n} for newline.
8038
8039 @item
8040 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
8041 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
8042 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
8043 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
8044 characters.
8045
8046 @item
8047 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
8048 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
8049
8050 @item
8051 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
8052 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
8053 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
8054 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
8055 @end itemize
8056
8057 @menu
8058 * C plus plus expressions::
8059 * C Defaults::
8060 * C Checks::
8061
8062 * Debugging C::
8063 @end menu
8064
8065 @node C plus plus expressions
8066 @subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
8067
8068 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
8069 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
8070
8071 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
8072 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
8073 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
8074 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
8075 @quotation
8076 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
8077 proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently, @value{GDBN}
8078 works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled with
8079 @value{NGCC} 2.95.3 or with @value{NGCC} 3.1 or newer, using the options
8080 @option{-gdwarf-2} or @option{-gstabs+}. DWARF 2 is preferred over
8081 stabs+. Most configurations of @value{NGCC} emit either DWARF 2 or
8082 stabs+ as their default debug format, so you usually don't need to
8083 specify a debug format explicitly. Other compilers and/or debug formats
8084 are likely to work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug
8085 C@t{++} code.
8086 @end quotation
8087
8088 @enumerate
8089
8090 @cindex member functions
8091 @item
8092 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
8093
8094 @smallexample
8095 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
8096 @end smallexample
8097
8098 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
8099 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
8100 @item
8101 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
8102 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
8103 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
8104 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
8105
8106 @cindex call overloaded functions
8107 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
8108 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
8109 @item
8110 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
8111 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
8112 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
8113 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
8114 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
8115 default arguments.
8116
8117 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
8118 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
8119 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
8120 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
8121 number of function arguments.
8122
8123 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
8124 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
8125 ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
8126
8127 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
8128 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
8129 @smallexample
8130 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
8131 @end smallexample
8132
8133 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
8134 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
8135
8136 @cindex reference declarations
8137 @item
8138 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
8139 them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
8140 dereferenced.
8141
8142 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
8143 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
8144 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
8145 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
8146 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
8147
8148 @item
8149 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
8150 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
8151 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
8152 necessary, for example in an expression like
8153 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
8154 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
8155 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
8156 @end enumerate
8157
8158 In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
8159 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
8160 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
8161 invoking user-defined operators.
8162
8163 @node C Defaults
8164 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
8165
8166 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
8167
8168 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
8169 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
8170 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8171 selects the working language.
8172
8173 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
8174 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
8175 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
8176 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
8177 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
8178 for further details.
8179
8180 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
8181 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
8182 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
8183
8184 @node C Checks
8185 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
8186
8187 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
8188
8189 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
8190 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
8191 considers two variables type equivalent if:
8192
8193 @itemize @bullet
8194 @item
8195 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
8196 enumerated tag.
8197
8198 @item
8199 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
8200 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
8201
8202 @ignore
8203 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
8204 @c FIXME--beers?
8205 @item
8206 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
8207 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
8208 compilers.)
8209 @end ignore
8210 @end itemize
8211
8212 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
8213 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
8214 that is not itself an array.
8215
8216 @node Debugging C
8217 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
8218
8219 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
8220 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
8221 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
8222 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
8223
8224 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
8225 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
8226 ,Expressions}.
8227
8228 @menu
8229 * Debugging C plus plus::
8230 @end menu
8231
8232 @node Debugging C plus plus
8233 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
8234
8235 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
8236
8237 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
8238 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
8239
8240 @table @code
8241 @cindex break in overloaded functions
8242 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
8243 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
8244 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
8245 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
8246
8247 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
8248 @item rbreak @var{regex}
8249 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
8250 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
8251 classes.
8252 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
8253
8254 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
8255 @item catch throw
8256 @itemx catch catch
8257 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
8258 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
8259
8260 @cindex inheritance
8261 @item ptype @var{typename}
8262 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
8263 @var{typename}.
8264 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
8265
8266 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
8267 @item set print demangle
8268 @itemx show print demangle
8269 @itemx set print asm-demangle
8270 @itemx show print asm-demangle
8271 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
8272 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
8273 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8274
8275 @item set print object
8276 @itemx show print object
8277 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
8278 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8279
8280 @item set print vtbl
8281 @itemx show print vtbl
8282 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
8283 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
8284 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
8285 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
8286
8287 @kindex set overload-resolution
8288 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
8289 @item set overload-resolution on
8290 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
8291 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
8292 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
8293 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
8294 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
8295 message.
8296
8297 @item set overload-resolution off
8298 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
8299 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8300 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
8301 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
8302 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
8303 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
8304 argument types.
8305
8306 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
8307 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
8308 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
8309 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
8310 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
8311 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
8312 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
8313 @end table
8314
8315 @node Modula-2
8316 @subsection Modula-2
8317
8318 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
8319
8320 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
8321 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
8322 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
8323 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
8324 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8325 table.
8326
8327 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
8328 @menu
8329 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
8330 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
8331 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
8332 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
8333 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
8334 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
8335 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8336 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8337 @end menu
8338
8339 @node M2 Operators
8340 @subsubsection Operators
8341 @cindex Modula-2 operators
8342
8343 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
8344 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
8345 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
8346 following definitions hold:
8347
8348 @itemize @bullet
8349
8350 @item
8351 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
8352 their subranges.
8353
8354 @item
8355 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
8356
8357 @item
8358 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
8359
8360 @item
8361 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
8362 @var{type}}.
8363
8364 @item
8365 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
8366
8367 @item
8368 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
8369
8370 @item
8371 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
8372 @end itemize
8373
8374 @noindent
8375 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
8376 increasing precedence:
8377
8378 @table @code
8379 @item ,
8380 Function argument or array index separator.
8381
8382 @item :=
8383 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
8384 @var{value}.
8385
8386 @item <@r{, }>
8387 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
8388 types.
8389
8390 @item <=@r{, }>=
8391 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
8392 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
8393 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
8394
8395 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
8396 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
8397 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
8398 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
8399 comment character.
8400
8401 @item IN
8402 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
8403 Same precedence as @code{<}.
8404
8405 @item OR
8406 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8407
8408 @item AND@r{, }&
8409 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
8410
8411 @item @@
8412 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
8413
8414 @item +@r{, }-
8415 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
8416 and difference on set types.
8417
8418 @item *
8419 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
8420 on set types.
8421
8422 @item /
8423 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
8424 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
8425
8426 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
8427 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
8428 precedence as @code{*}.
8429
8430 @item -
8431 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
8432
8433 @item ^
8434 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
8435
8436 @item NOT
8437 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
8438 @code{^}.
8439
8440 @item .
8441 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
8442 precedence as @code{^}.
8443
8444 @item []
8445 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
8446
8447 @item ()
8448 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
8449 as @code{^}.
8450
8451 @item ::@r{, }.
8452 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
8453 @end table
8454
8455 @quotation
8456 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
8457 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
8458 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
8459 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
8460 @end quotation
8461
8462
8463 @node Built-In Func/Proc
8464 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
8465 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
8466
8467 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
8468 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
8469
8470 @table @var
8471
8472 @item a
8473 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
8474
8475 @item c
8476 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
8477
8478 @item i
8479 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
8480
8481 @item m
8482 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
8483 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
8484 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
8485
8486 @item n
8487 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
8488
8489 @item r
8490 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
8491
8492 @item t
8493 represents a type.
8494
8495 @item v
8496 represents a variable.
8497
8498 @item x
8499 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
8500 explanation of the function for details.
8501 @end table
8502
8503 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
8504
8505 @table @code
8506 @item ABS(@var{n})
8507 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
8508
8509 @item CAP(@var{c})
8510 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
8511 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
8512
8513 @item CHR(@var{i})
8514 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8515
8516 @item DEC(@var{v})
8517 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8518
8519 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
8520 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8521 new value.
8522
8523 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8524 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
8525 set.
8526
8527 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
8528 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
8529
8530 @item HIGH(@var{a})
8531 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
8532
8533 @item INC(@var{v})
8534 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
8535
8536 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
8537 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
8538 new value.
8539
8540 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
8541 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
8542 there. Returns the new set.
8543
8544 @item MAX(@var{t})
8545 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
8546
8547 @item MIN(@var{t})
8548 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
8549
8550 @item ODD(@var{i})
8551 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
8552
8553 @item ORD(@var{x})
8554 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
8555 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
8556 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
8557 integral, character and enumerated types.
8558
8559 @item SIZE(@var{x})
8560 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
8561
8562 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
8563 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
8564
8565 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
8566 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
8567 @end table
8568
8569 @quotation
8570 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
8571 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
8572 an error.
8573 @end quotation
8574
8575 @cindex Modula-2 constants
8576 @node M2 Constants
8577 @subsubsection Constants
8578
8579 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
8580 ways:
8581
8582 @itemize @bullet
8583
8584 @item
8585 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
8586 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
8587 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
8588 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
8589
8590 @item
8591 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
8592 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
8593 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
8594 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
8595 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
8596 digits.
8597
8598 @item
8599 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
8600 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
8601 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
8602 followed by a @samp{C}.
8603
8604 @item
8605 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
8606 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
8607 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
8608 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
8609 sequences.
8610
8611 @item
8612 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
8613
8614 @item
8615 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
8616 @code{FALSE}.
8617
8618 @item
8619 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
8620
8621 @item
8622 Set constants are not yet supported.
8623 @end itemize
8624
8625 @node M2 Defaults
8626 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
8627 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
8628
8629 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8630 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
8631 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
8632 selected the working language.
8633
8634 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8635 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
8636 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
8637 the language automatically}, for further details.
8638
8639 @node Deviations
8640 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
8641 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
8642
8643 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
8644 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
8645
8646 @itemize @bullet
8647 @item
8648 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
8649 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
8650 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
8651 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
8652 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
8653 returned a pointer.)
8654
8655 @item
8656 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
8657 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
8658 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
8659 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
8660
8661 @item
8662 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
8663 argument.
8664
8665 @item
8666 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
8667 @end itemize
8668
8669 @node M2 Checks
8670 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
8671 @cindex Modula-2 checks
8672
8673 @quotation
8674 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
8675 range checking.
8676 @end quotation
8677 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
8678
8679 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
8680
8681 @itemize @bullet
8682 @item
8683 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
8684 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
8685
8686 @item
8687 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
8688 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
8689 @end itemize
8690
8691 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
8692 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
8693
8694 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8695 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
8696
8697 @node M2 Scope
8698 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
8699 @cindex scope
8700 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
8701 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
8702 @ifinfo
8703 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
8704 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
8705 @end ifinfo
8706 @iftex
8707 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
8708 @end iftex
8709
8710 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
8711 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8712 similar syntax:
8713
8714 @smallexample
8715
8716 @var{module} . @var{id}
8717 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
8718 @end smallexample
8719
8720 @noindent
8721 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8722 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8723 identifier within your program, except another module.
8724
8725 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8726 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8727 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8728 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8729
8730 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8731 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8732 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8733 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8734 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8735 @var{module}.
8736
8737 @node GDB/M2
8738 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8739
8740 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8741 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
8742 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
8743 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
8744 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
8745 analogue in Modula-2.
8746
8747 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
8748 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
8749 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
8750 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
8751 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
8752 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
8753
8754 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8755 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8756 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
8757
8758 @node Symbols
8759 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8760
8761 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
8762 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8763 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8764 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8765 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8766 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8767 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8768
8769 @cindex symbol names
8770 @cindex names of symbols
8771 @cindex quoting names
8772 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8773 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8774 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8775 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8776 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8777 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8778 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8779 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8780
8781 @smallexample
8782 p 'foo.c'::x
8783 @end smallexample
8784
8785 @noindent
8786 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8787
8788 @table @code
8789 @kindex info address
8790 @cindex address of a symbol
8791 @item info address @var{symbol}
8792 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8793 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8794 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8795 is always stored.
8796
8797 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8798 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8799 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8800
8801 @kindex info symbol
8802 @cindex symbol from address
8803 @item info symbol @var{addr}
8804 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8805 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8806 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8807
8808 @smallexample
8809 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8810 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8811 @end smallexample
8812
8813 @noindent
8814 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8815 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8816
8817 @kindex whatis
8818 @item whatis @var{expr}
8819 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
8820 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8821 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8822 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8823
8824 @item whatis
8825 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8826
8827 @kindex ptype
8828 @item ptype @var{typename}
8829 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
8830 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8831 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8832 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
8833
8834 @item ptype @var{expr}
8835 @itemx ptype
8836 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
8837 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8838 of just the name of the type.
8839
8840 For example, for this variable declaration:
8841
8842 @smallexample
8843 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8844 @end smallexample
8845
8846 @noindent
8847 the two commands give this output:
8848
8849 @smallexample
8850 @group
8851 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8852 type = struct complex
8853 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8854 type = struct complex @{
8855 double real;
8856 double imag;
8857 @}
8858 @end group
8859 @end smallexample
8860
8861 @noindent
8862 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8863 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8864
8865 @kindex info types
8866 @item info types @var{regexp}
8867 @itemx info types
8868 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
8869 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8870 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8871 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
8872 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
8873 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8874
8875 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8876 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8877 lists all source files where a type is defined.
8878
8879 @kindex info scope
8880 @cindex local variables
8881 @item info scope @var{addr}
8882 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8883 accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8884 preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8885 scope defined by that location. For example:
8886
8887 @smallexample
8888 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8889 Scope for command_line_handler:
8890 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8891 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8892 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8893 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8894 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8895 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8896 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8897 @end smallexample
8898
8899 @noindent
8900 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8901 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8902 collect}.
8903
8904 @kindex info source
8905 @item info source
8906 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
8907 the function containing the current point of execution:
8908 @itemize @bullet
8909 @item
8910 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
8911 @item
8912 the directory it was compiled in,
8913 @item
8914 its length, in lines,
8915 @item
8916 which programming language it is written in,
8917 @item
8918 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
8919 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
8920 @item
8921 whether the debugging information includes information about
8922 preprocessor macros.
8923 @end itemize
8924
8925
8926 @kindex info sources
8927 @item info sources
8928 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8929 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8930 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8931
8932 @kindex info functions
8933 @item info functions
8934 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8935
8936 @item info functions @var{regexp}
8937 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8938 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8939 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8940 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
8941 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8942 that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8943 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
8944
8945 @kindex info variables
8946 @item info variables
8947 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8948 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
8949
8950 @item info variables @var{regexp}
8951 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8952 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8953 @var{regexp}.
8954
8955 @ignore
8956 This was never implemented.
8957 @kindex info methods
8958 @item info methods
8959 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8960 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
8961 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8962 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8963 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
8964 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8965 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8966 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8967 @end ignore
8968
8969 @cindex reloading symbols
8970 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
8971 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8972 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8973 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8974 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
8975
8976 @table @code
8977 @kindex set symbol-reloading
8978 @item set symbol-reloading on
8979 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8980 object file with a particular name is seen again.
8981
8982 @item set symbol-reloading off
8983 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8984 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8985 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8986 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8987 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8988 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8989 name.
8990
8991 @kindex show symbol-reloading
8992 @item show symbol-reloading
8993 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8994 @end table
8995
8996 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8997 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
8998 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8999 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
9000 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
9001 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
9002 another source file. The default is on.
9003
9004 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
9005 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
9006
9007 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
9008 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
9009 is printed as follows:
9010 @smallexample
9011 @{<no data fields>@}
9012 @end smallexample
9013
9014 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
9015 @item show opaque-type-resolution
9016 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
9017
9018 @kindex maint print symbols
9019 @cindex symbol dump
9020 @kindex maint print psymbols
9021 @cindex partial symbol dump
9022 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
9023 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
9024 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
9025 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
9026 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
9027 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
9028 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
9029 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
9030 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
9031 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
9032 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
9033 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
9034 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
9035 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
9036 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
9037 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
9038 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
9039 @end table
9040
9041 @node Altering
9042 @chapter Altering Execution
9043
9044 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
9045 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
9046 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
9047 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
9048 program.
9049
9050 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
9051 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
9052 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
9053
9054 @menu
9055 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
9056 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
9057 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
9058 * Returning:: Returning from a function
9059 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
9060 * Patching:: Patching your program
9061 @end menu
9062
9063 @node Assignment
9064 @section Assignment to variables
9065
9066 @cindex assignment
9067 @cindex setting variables
9068 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
9069 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
9070
9071 @smallexample
9072 print x=4
9073 @end smallexample
9074
9075 @noindent
9076 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
9077 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
9078 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
9079 information on operators in supported languages.
9080
9081 @kindex set variable
9082 @cindex variables, setting
9083 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
9084 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
9085 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
9086 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
9087 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
9088
9089 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
9090 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
9091 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
9092 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
9093 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
9094 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
9095 command @code{set width}:
9096
9097 @smallexample
9098 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
9099 type = double
9100 (@value{GDBP}) p width
9101 $4 = 13
9102 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
9103 Invalid syntax in expression.
9104 @end smallexample
9105
9106 @noindent
9107 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
9108 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
9109
9110 @smallexample
9111 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
9112 @end smallexample
9113
9114 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
9115 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
9116 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
9117 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
9118 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
9119 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
9120
9121 @smallexample
9122 @group
9123 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
9124 type = double
9125 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9126 $1 = 1
9127 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
9128 (@value{GDBP}) p g
9129 $2 = 1
9130 (@value{GDBP}) r
9131 The program being debugged has been started already.
9132 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
9133 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
9134 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
9135 Invalid bfd target.
9136 (@value{GDBP}) show g
9137 The current BFD target is "=4".
9138 @end group
9139 @end smallexample
9140
9141 @noindent
9142 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
9143 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
9144 @code{g}, use
9145
9146 @smallexample
9147 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
9148 @end smallexample
9149
9150 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
9151 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
9152 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
9153 same length or shorter.
9154 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
9155 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
9156
9157 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
9158 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
9159 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
9160 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
9161 and representation in memory), and
9162
9163 @smallexample
9164 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
9165 @end smallexample
9166
9167 @noindent
9168 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
9169
9170 @node Jumping
9171 @section Continuing at a different address
9172
9173 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
9174 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
9175 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
9176
9177 @table @code
9178 @kindex jump
9179 @item jump @var{linespec}
9180 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
9181 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
9182 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
9183 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
9184 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
9185 breakpoints}.
9186
9187 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
9188 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
9189 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
9190 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
9191 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
9192 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
9193 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
9194 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
9195 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
9196
9197 @item jump *@var{address}
9198 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
9199 @end table
9200
9201 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
9202 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
9203 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
9204 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
9205 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
9206 example,
9207
9208 @smallexample
9209 set $pc = 0x485
9210 @end smallexample
9211
9212 @noindent
9213 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
9214 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
9215 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
9216
9217 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
9218 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
9219 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
9220 detail.
9221
9222 @c @group
9223 @node Signaling
9224 @section Giving your program a signal
9225
9226 @table @code
9227 @kindex signal
9228 @item signal @var{signal}
9229 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9230 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9231 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9232 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9233
9234 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9235 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9236 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9237 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9238 signal.
9239
9240 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9241 after executing the command.
9242 @end table
9243 @c @end group
9244
9245 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9246 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9247 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9248 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9249 passes the signal directly to your program.
9250
9251
9252 @node Returning
9253 @section Returning from a function
9254
9255 @table @code
9256 @cindex returning from a function
9257 @kindex return
9258 @item return
9259 @itemx return @var{expression}
9260 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9261 command. If you give an
9262 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9263 value.
9264 @end table
9265
9266 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9267 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9268 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9269 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9270
9271 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9272 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9273 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9274 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9275 of functions.
9276
9277 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9278 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9279 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9280 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9281 selected stack frame returns naturally.
9282
9283 @node Calling
9284 @section Calling program functions
9285
9286 @cindex calling functions
9287 @kindex call
9288 @table @code
9289 @item call @var{expr}
9290 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9291 returned values.
9292 @end table
9293
9294 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9295 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
9296 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9297 is printed and saved in the value history.
9298
9299 @node Patching
9300 @section Patching programs
9301
9302 @cindex patching binaries
9303 @cindex writing into executables
9304 @cindex writing into corefiles
9305
9306 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9307 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9308 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9309 patching your program's binary.
9310
9311 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9312 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9313 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9314 repairs.
9315
9316 @table @code
9317 @kindex set write
9318 @item set write on
9319 @itemx set write off
9320 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9321 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
9322 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9323
9324 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
9325 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9326 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
9327
9328 @item show write
9329 @kindex show write
9330 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9331 as well as reading.
9332 @end table
9333
9334 @node GDB Files
9335 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9336
9337 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9338 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9339 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9340 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
9341
9342 @menu
9343 * Files:: Commands to specify files
9344 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
9345 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9346 @end menu
9347
9348 @node Files
9349 @section Commands to specify files
9350
9351 @cindex symbol table
9352 @cindex core dump file
9353
9354 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9355 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9356 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9357 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
9358
9359 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9360 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9361 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9362 to specify new files are useful.
9363
9364 @table @code
9365 @cindex executable file
9366 @kindex file
9367 @item file @var{filename}
9368 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9369 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9370 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
9371 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9372 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9373 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9374 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
9375 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9376
9377 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
9378 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9379 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9380 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9381 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9382 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
9383 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
9384 for more information.
9385
9386 @item file
9387 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9388 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9389
9390 @kindex exec-file
9391 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9392 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9393 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9394 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9395 discard information on the executable file.
9396
9397 @kindex symbol-file
9398 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9399 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9400 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9401 table and program to run from the same file.
9402
9403 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9404 program's symbol table.
9405
9406 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
9407 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9408 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9409 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9410 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9411
9412 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9413 executing it once.
9414
9415 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9416 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9417 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9418 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
9419 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9420 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9421 optimized code.
9422
9423 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9424 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9425 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9426 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9427 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9428
9429 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9430 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9431 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9432 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9433 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9434 warnings and messages}.)
9435
9436 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9437 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9438 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9439 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9440 in stabs format.
9441
9442 @kindex readnow
9443 @cindex reading symbols immediately
9444 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
9445 @kindex mapped
9446 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9447 @cindex saving symbol table
9448 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9449 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9450 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9451 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9452 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
9453 entire symbol table available.
9454
9455 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9456 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9457 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9458 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9459 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9460 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9461 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9462 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9463
9464 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9465 file has all the symbol information for your program.
9466
9467 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9468 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9469 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9470 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9471 needed.
9472
9473 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9474 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9475 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
9476
9477 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9478 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9479 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9480 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9481 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9482 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9483 @c files.
9484
9485 @kindex core
9486 @kindex core-file
9487 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9488 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9489 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9490 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9491 executable file itself for other parts.
9492
9493 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9494 to be used.
9495
9496 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
9497 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9498 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9499 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
9500 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
9501
9502 @kindex add-symbol-file
9503 @cindex dynamic linking
9504 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9505 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9506 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
9507 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9508 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9509 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9510 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9511 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
9512 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9513 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9514 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9515 @var{address} as an expression.
9516
9517 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9518 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
9519 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9520 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9521 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
9522
9523 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9524 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9525 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9526 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9527 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9528 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9529 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9530 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9531 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9532
9533 @itemize @bullet
9534 @item
9535 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9536 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9537 @item
9538 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9539 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9540 @item
9541 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9542 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9543 @end itemize
9544
9545 @noindent
9546 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9547 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9548 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9549 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9550 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9551 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9552 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9553 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9554 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9555 way.
9556
9557 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9558
9559 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9560 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9561 table information for @var{filename}.
9562
9563 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9564 @item add-shared-symbol-file
9565 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
9566 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9567 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
9568 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
9569
9570 @kindex section
9571 @item section
9572 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9573 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9574 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9575 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
9576 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9577 the sections and their addresses.
9578
9579 @kindex info files
9580 @kindex info target
9581 @item info files
9582 @itemx info target
9583 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9584 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9585 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9586 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9587 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9588 current ones.
9589
9590 @kindex maint info sections
9591 @item maint info sections
9592 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9593 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9594 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9595 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9596 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9597 may be arbitrarily combined):
9598
9599 @table @code
9600 @item ALLOBJ
9601 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9602 @item @var{sections}
9603 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
9604 @item @var{section-flags}
9605 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9606 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9607 @table @code
9608 @item ALLOC
9609 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9610 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9611 @item LOAD
9612 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9613 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9614 @item RELOC
9615 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9616 @item READONLY
9617 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9618 @item CODE
9619 Section contains executable code only.
9620 @item DATA
9621 Section contains data only (no executable code).
9622 @item ROM
9623 Section will reside in ROM.
9624 @item CONSTRUCTOR
9625 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9626 @item HAS_CONTENTS
9627 Section is not empty.
9628 @item NEVER_LOAD
9629 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9630 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9631 A notification to the linker that the section contains
9632 COFF shared library information.
9633 @item IS_COMMON
9634 Section contains common symbols.
9635 @end table
9636 @end table
9637 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9638 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
9639 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9640 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
9641 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9642 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9643 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9644 enhancement to debugging performance.
9645
9646 The default is off.
9647
9648 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
9649 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9650 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9651 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
9652 @end table
9653
9654 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9655 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9656 name and remembers it that way.
9657
9658 @cindex shared libraries
9659 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9660 libraries.
9661
9662 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9663 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9664 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9665 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9666 debugging a core file).
9667
9668 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9669 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9670
9671 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9672 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9673 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9674
9675 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9676 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9677 particularly large or there are many of them.
9678
9679 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9680 commands:
9681
9682 @table @code
9683 @kindex set auto-solib-add
9684 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9685 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9686 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9687 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9688 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9689 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9690 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9691
9692 @kindex show auto-solib-add
9693 @item show auto-solib-add
9694 Display the current autoloading mode.
9695 @end table
9696
9697 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9698 command:
9699
9700 @table @code
9701 @kindex info sharedlibrary
9702 @kindex info share
9703 @item info share
9704 @itemx info sharedlibrary
9705 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9706
9707 @kindex sharedlibrary
9708 @kindex share
9709 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9710 @itemx share @var{regex}
9711 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9712 Unix regular expression.
9713 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9714 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9715 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9716 loaded.
9717 @end table
9718
9719 On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9720 autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9721 reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9722 by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9723 up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9724 wish.
9725
9726 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
9727 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9728 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
9729 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9730
9731 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9732
9733 @table @code
9734 @kindex set auto-solib-limit
9735 @item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9736 Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9737 If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9738 symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9739 size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
9740 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9741 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e.@: 100
9742 Mb).
9743
9744 @kindex show auto-solib-limit
9745 @item show auto-solib-limit
9746 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9747 @end table
9748
9749 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
9750 configurations. A copy of the target's libraries need to be present on the
9751 host system; they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
9752 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
9753 not.
9754
9755 You need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target libraries are, so that it can
9756 load the correct copies---otherwise, it may try to load the host's libraries.
9757 @value{GDBN} has two variables to specify the search directories for target
9758 libraries.
9759
9760 @table @code
9761 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
9762 @item set solib-absolute-prefix @var{path}
9763 If this variable is set, @var{path} will be used as a prefix for any
9764 absolute shared library paths; many runtime loaders store the absolute
9765 paths to the shared library in the target program's memory. If you use
9766 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to find shared libraries, they need to be laid
9767 out in the same way that they are on the target, with e.g.@: a
9768 @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under @var{path}.
9769
9770 You can set the default value of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} by using the
9771 configure-time @samp{--with-sysroot} option.
9772
9773 @kindex show solib-absolute-prefix
9774 @item show solib-absolute-prefix
9775 Display the current shared library prefix.
9776
9777 @kindex set solib-search-path
9778 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
9779 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of directories
9780 to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path} is used after
9781 @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} fails to locate the library, or if the path to
9782 the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to use
9783 @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}, be sure to
9784 set @samp{solib-absolute-prefix} to a nonexistant directory to prevent
9785 @value{GDBN} from finding your host's libraries.
9786
9787 @kindex show solib-search-path
9788 @item show solib-search-path
9789 Display the current shared library search path.
9790 @end table
9791
9792
9793 @node Separate Debug Files
9794 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
9795 @cindex separate debugging information files
9796 @cindex debugging information in separate files
9797 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
9798 @cindex debugging information directory, global
9799 @cindex global debugging information directory
9800
9801 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
9802 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
9803 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
9804 Since debugging information can be very large --- sometimes larger
9805 than the executable code itself --- some systems distribute debugging
9806 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
9807 install only when they need to debug a problem.
9808
9809 If an executable's debugging information has been extracted to a
9810 separate file, the executable should contain a @dfn{debug link} giving
9811 the name of the debugging information file (with no directory
9812 components), and a checksum of its contents. (The exact form of a
9813 debug link is described below.) If the full name of the directory
9814 containing the executable is @var{execdir}, and the executable has a
9815 debug link that specifies the name @var{debugfile}, then @value{GDBN}
9816 will automatically search for the debugging information file in three
9817 places:
9818
9819 @itemize @bullet
9820 @item
9821 the directory containing the executable file (that is, it will look
9822 for a file named @file{@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}},
9823 @item
9824 a subdirectory of that directory named @file{.debug} (that is, the
9825 file @file{@var{execdir}/.debug/@var{debugfile}}, and
9826 @item
9827 a subdirectory of the global debug file directory that includes the
9828 executable's full path, and the name from the link (that is, the file
9829 @file{@var{globaldebugdir}/@var{execdir}/@var{debugfile}}, where
9830 @var{globaldebugdir} is the global debug file directory, and
9831 @var{execdir} has been turned into a relative path).
9832 @end itemize
9833 @noindent
9834 @value{GDBN} checks under each of these names for a debugging
9835 information file whose checksum matches that given in the link, and
9836 reads the debugging information from the first one it finds.
9837
9838 So, for example, if you ask @value{GDBN} to debug @file{/usr/bin/ls},
9839 which has a link containing the name @file{ls.debug}, and the global
9840 debug directory is @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look
9841 for debug information in @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug},
9842 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}, and
9843 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
9844
9845 You can set the global debugging info directory's name, and view the
9846 name @value{GDBN} is currently using.
9847
9848 @table @code
9849
9850 @kindex set debug-file-directory
9851 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directory}
9852 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9853 information files to @var{directory}.
9854
9855 @kindex show debug-file-directory
9856 @item show debug-file-directory
9857 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
9858 information files.
9859
9860 @end table
9861
9862 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
9863 @cindex debug links
9864 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
9865 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
9866
9867 @itemize
9868 @item
9869 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
9870 a zero byte,
9871 @item
9872 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
9873 boundary within the section, and
9874 @item
9875 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
9876 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
9877 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
9878 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
9879 @end itemize
9880
9881 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
9882 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
9883 described above.
9884
9885 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
9886 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
9887 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
9888 should have the same names, addresses and sizes as the original file,
9889 but they need not contain any data --- much like a @code{.bss} section
9890 in an ordinary executable.
9891
9892 As of December 2002, there is no standard GNU utility to produce
9893 separated executable / debugging information file pairs. Ulrich
9894 Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53,
9895 contains a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command
9896 @kbd{strip foo -f foo.debug} removes the debugging information from
9897 the executable file @file{foo}, places it in the file
9898 @file{foo.debug}, and leaves behind a debug link in @file{foo}.
9899
9900 Since there are many different ways to compute CRC's (different
9901 polynomials, reversals, byte ordering, etc.), the simplest way to
9902 describe the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections is to give the
9903 complete code for a function that computes it:
9904
9905 @kindex @code{gnu_debuglink_crc32}
9906 @smallexample
9907 unsigned long
9908 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
9909 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
9910 @{
9911 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
9912 @{
9913 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
9914 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
9915 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
9916 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
9917 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
9918 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
9919 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
9920 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
9921 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
9922 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
9923 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
9924 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
9925 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
9926 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
9927 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
9928 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
9929 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
9930 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
9931 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
9932 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
9933 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
9934 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
9935 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
9936 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
9937 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
9938 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
9939 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
9940 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
9941 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
9942 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
9943 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
9944 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
9945 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
9946 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
9947 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
9948 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
9949 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
9950 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
9951 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
9952 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
9953 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
9954 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
9955 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
9956 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
9957 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
9958 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
9959 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
9960 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
9961 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
9962 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
9963 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
9964 0x2d02ef8d
9965 @};
9966 unsigned char *end;
9967
9968 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
9969 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
9970 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
9971 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;;
9972 @}
9973 @end smallexample
9974
9975
9976 @node Symbol Errors
9977 @section Errors reading symbol files
9978
9979 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9980 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9981 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9982 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9983 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9984 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9985 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9986 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9987 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9988 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9989 messages}).
9990
9991 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9992
9993 @table @code
9994 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9995
9996 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9997 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9998 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9999 in its outer scope blocks.
10000
10001 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
10002 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
10003 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
10004 function.
10005
10006 @item block at @var{address} out of order
10007
10008 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
10009 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
10010 do so.
10011
10012 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
10013 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
10014 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
10015 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
10016 messages}.)
10017
10018 @item bad block start address patched
10019
10020 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
10021 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
10022 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
10023
10024 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
10025 starting on the previous source line.
10026
10027 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
10028
10029 @cindex foo
10030 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
10031 larger than the size of the string table.
10032
10033 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
10034 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
10035 with this name.
10036
10037 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
10038
10039 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
10040 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
10041 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
10042
10043 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
10044 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
10045 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
10046 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
10047 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
10048 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
10049
10050 @item stub type has NULL name
10051
10052 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
10053
10054 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
10055 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
10056 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
10057 it.
10058
10059 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
10060
10061 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
10062
10063 @end table
10064
10065 @node Targets
10066 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
10067
10068 @cindex debugging target
10069 @kindex target
10070
10071 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
10072
10073 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
10074 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
10075 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
10076 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
10077 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
10078 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
10079 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
10080 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10081
10082 @menu
10083 * Active Targets:: Active targets
10084 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
10085 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
10086 * Remote:: Remote debugging
10087 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
10088
10089 @end menu
10090
10091 @node Active Targets
10092 @section Active targets
10093
10094 @cindex stacking targets
10095 @cindex active targets
10096 @cindex multiple targets
10097
10098 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
10099 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
10100 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
10101 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
10102 a core file.
10103
10104 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
10105 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
10106 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
10107 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
10108 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
10109 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
10110 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
10111 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
10112 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
10113
10114 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
10115 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
10116 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
10117 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
10118 process target is active.
10119
10120 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
10121 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
10122 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
10123 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
10124 process}).
10125
10126 @node Target Commands
10127 @section Commands for managing targets
10128
10129 @table @code
10130 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
10131 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
10132 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
10133 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
10134 protocol of the target machine.
10135
10136 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
10137 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
10138 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
10139
10140 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
10141 after executing the command.
10142
10143 @kindex help target
10144 @item help target
10145 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
10146 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
10147 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
10148
10149 @item help target @var{name}
10150 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
10151 select it.
10152
10153 @kindex set gnutarget
10154 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
10155 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
10156 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
10157 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
10158 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
10159 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
10160
10161 @quotation
10162 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
10163 you must know the actual BFD name.
10164 @end quotation
10165
10166 @noindent
10167 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
10168
10169 @kindex show gnutarget
10170 @item show gnutarget
10171 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
10172 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
10173 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
10174 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
10175 @end table
10176
10177 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
10178 configuration):
10179
10180 @table @code
10181 @kindex target exec
10182 @item target exec @var{program}
10183 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
10184 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
10185
10186 @kindex target core
10187 @item target core @var{filename}
10188 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
10189 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
10190
10191 @kindex target remote
10192 @item target remote @var{dev}
10193 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
10194 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
10195 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
10196 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
10197 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
10198 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
10199
10200 @kindex target sim
10201 @item target sim
10202 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
10203 In general,
10204 @smallexample
10205 target sim
10206 load
10207 run
10208 @end smallexample
10209 @noindent
10210 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
10211 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
10212 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
10213 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
10214 Processors}.
10215
10216 @end table
10217
10218 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
10219
10220 @table @code
10221
10222 @kindex target nrom
10223 @item target nrom @var{dev}
10224 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
10225
10226 @end table
10227
10228 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
10229 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
10230
10231 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
10232 once you've successfully established a connection.
10233
10234 @table @code
10235
10236 @kindex load @var{filename}
10237 @item load @var{filename}
10238 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
10239 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
10240 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
10241 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
10242 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
10243 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
10244
10245 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
10246 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
10247 target is @dots{}}''
10248
10249 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
10250 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
10251 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
10252 specifies a fixed address.
10253 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
10254
10255 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10256 @end table
10257
10258 @node Byte Order
10259 @section Choosing target byte order
10260
10261 @cindex choosing target byte order
10262 @cindex target byte order
10263
10264 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
10265 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
10266 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
10267 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
10268 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
10269 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
10270
10271 @table @code
10272 @kindex set endian big
10273 @item set endian big
10274 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
10275
10276 @kindex set endian little
10277 @item set endian little
10278 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
10279
10280 @kindex set endian auto
10281 @item set endian auto
10282 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
10283 executable.
10284
10285 @item show endian
10286 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
10287
10288 @end table
10289
10290 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
10291 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
10292 target system.
10293
10294 @node Remote
10295 @section Remote debugging
10296 @cindex remote debugging
10297
10298 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
10299 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
10300 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
10301 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
10302 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
10303
10304 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
10305 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
10306 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
10307 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
10308 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
10309 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
10310
10311 Other remote targets may be available in your
10312 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
10313
10314 @node KOD
10315 @section Kernel Object Display
10316
10317 @cindex kernel object display
10318 @cindex kernel object
10319 @cindex KOD
10320
10321 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
10322 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
10323 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
10324 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
10325 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
10326
10327 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
10328 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
10329
10330 @smallexample
10331 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
10332 @end smallexample
10333
10334 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
10335 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
10336 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
10337 after the operating system:
10338
10339 @smallexample
10340 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
10341 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
10342 Object Description
10343 any Any and all objects
10344 @end smallexample
10345
10346 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
10347 by the kernel.
10348
10349 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
10350 is supported other than to try it.
10351
10352
10353 @node Remote Debugging
10354 @chapter Debugging remote programs
10355
10356 @menu
10357 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
10358 * NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
10359 * Remote configuration:: Remote configuration
10360 * remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
10361 @end menu
10362
10363 @node Server
10364 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
10365
10366 @kindex gdbserver
10367 @cindex remote connection without stubs
10368 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
10369 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10370 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
10371
10372 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
10373 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
10374 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
10375 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
10376 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
10377 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
10378 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
10379 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
10380 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
10381 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
10382 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
10383 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
10384 choice for debugging.
10385
10386 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
10387 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
10388 protocol.
10389
10390 @table @emph
10391 @item On the target machine,
10392 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10393 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
10394 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
10395 system does all the symbol handling.
10396
10397 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
10398 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
10399 syntax is:
10400
10401 @smallexample
10402 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10403 @end smallexample
10404
10405 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
10406 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
10407 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
10408 @file{/dev/com1}:
10409
10410 @smallexample
10411 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
10412 @end smallexample
10413
10414 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
10415 with it.
10416
10417 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
10418
10419 @smallexample
10420 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
10421 @end smallexample
10422
10423 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
10424 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
10425 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
10426 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
10427 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
10428 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
10429 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
10430 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
10431 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
10432 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
10433 @code{target remote} command.
10434
10435 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
10436 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
10437
10438 @smallexample
10439 target> gdbserver @var{comm} --attach @var{pid}
10440 @end smallexample
10441
10442 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't necessary
10443 to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
10444
10445 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10446 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10447 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10448 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10449 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10450 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
10451 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
10452 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
10453 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
10454 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
10455
10456 @smallexample
10457 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10458 @end smallexample
10459
10460 @noindent
10461 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10462
10463 @smallexample
10464 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10465 @end smallexample
10466
10467 @noindent
10468 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10469 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10470 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10471 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10472 @samp{Connection refused}.
10473 @end table
10474
10475 @node NetWare
10476 @section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10477
10478 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
10479 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10480 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10481 @code{target remote}.
10482
10483 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10484 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10485
10486 @table @emph
10487 @item On the target machine,
10488 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10489 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10490 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10491 host system does all the symbol handling.
10492
10493 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10494 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10495 program. The syntax is:
10496
10497 @smallexample
10498 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10499 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10500 @end smallexample
10501
10502 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10503 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10504 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10505
10506 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10507 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10508 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10509
10510 @smallexample
10511 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10512 @end smallexample
10513
10514 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10515 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10516 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10517 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10518 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10519 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10520 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10521 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10522 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10523
10524 @smallexample
10525 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10526 @end smallexample
10527
10528 @noindent
10529 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10530 @end table
10531
10532 @node Remote configuration
10533 @section Remote configuration
10534
10535 The following configuration options are available when debugging remote
10536 programs:
10537
10538 @table @code
10539 @kindex set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
10540 @kindex set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
10541 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
10542 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
10543 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
10544 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
10545 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware breakpoint or
10546 watchpoints. A limit of -1, the default, is treated as unlimited.
10547 @end table
10548
10549 @node remote stub
10550 @section Implementing a remote stub
10551
10552 @cindex debugging stub, example
10553 @cindex remote stub, example
10554 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
10555 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10556 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10557 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10558 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10559 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10560 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10561 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10562
10563 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10564 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10565 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10566 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10567 program, you need:
10568
10569 @enumerate
10570 @item
10571 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10572 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10573 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
10574
10575 @item
10576 A C subroutine library to support your program's
10577 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
10578
10579 @item
10580 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10581 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10582 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10583 documentation.
10584 @end enumerate
10585
10586 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10587 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10588 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
10589
10590 @table @emph
10591 @item On the host,
10592 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10593 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10594 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10595
10596 @item On the target,
10597 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10598 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10599 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10600
10601 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10602 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10603 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10604 @end table
10605
10606 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10607 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10608 @sc{sparc} boards.
10609
10610 @cindex remote serial stub list
10611 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
10612
10613 @table @code
10614
10615 @item i386-stub.c
10616 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
10617 @cindex Intel
10618 @cindex i386
10619 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10620
10621 @item m68k-stub.c
10622 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
10623 @cindex Motorola 680x0
10624 @cindex m680x0
10625 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10626
10627 @item sh-stub.c
10628 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
10629 @cindex Hitachi
10630 @cindex SH
10631 For Hitachi SH architectures.
10632
10633 @item sparc-stub.c
10634 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
10635 @cindex Sparc
10636 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10637
10638 @item sparcl-stub.c
10639 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
10640 @cindex Fujitsu
10641 @cindex SparcLite
10642 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10643
10644 @end table
10645
10646 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10647 recently added stubs.
10648
10649 @menu
10650 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10651 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10652 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
10653 @end menu
10654
10655 @node Stub Contents
10656 @subsection What the stub can do for you
10657
10658 @cindex remote serial stub
10659 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10660 subroutines:
10661
10662 @table @code
10663 @item set_debug_traps
10664 @kindex set_debug_traps
10665 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10666 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10667 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10668 beginning of your program.
10669
10670 @item handle_exception
10671 @kindex handle_exception
10672 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10673 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10674 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10675 run when a trap is triggered.
10676
10677 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10678 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10679 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10680 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
10681 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
10682 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10683 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10684 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10685 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
10686 machine.
10687
10688 @item breakpoint
10689 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10690 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10691 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10692 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10693 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10694 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10695 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10696 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10697 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10698 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
10699 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
10700
10701 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10702 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10703 start of your debugging session.
10704 @end table
10705
10706 @node Bootstrapping
10707 @subsection What you must do for the stub
10708
10709 @cindex remote stub, support routines
10710 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10711 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10712 debugging target machine.
10713
10714 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10715 serial port.
10716
10717 @table @code
10718 @item int getDebugChar()
10719 @kindex getDebugChar
10720 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10721 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10722 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10723
10724 @item void putDebugChar(int)
10725 @kindex putDebugChar
10726 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
10727 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
10728 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10729 @end table
10730
10731 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
10732 @cindex interrupting remote targets
10733 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10734 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10735 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10736 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10737 remote system to stop.
10738
10739 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10740 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10741 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10742 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10743
10744 Other routines you need to supply are:
10745
10746 @table @code
10747 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10748 @kindex exceptionHandler
10749 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10750 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10751 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10752 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10753 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10754 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10755 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10756 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10757 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10758 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10759 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10760 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10761 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10762
10763 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10764 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10765 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10766 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10767 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10768
10769 @item void flush_i_cache()
10770 @kindex flush_i_cache
10771 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
10772 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10773 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10774
10775 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10776 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10777 @end table
10778
10779 @noindent
10780 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10781
10782 @table @code
10783 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10784 @kindex memset
10785 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10786 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10787 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10788 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10789 @end table
10790
10791 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10792 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10793 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
10794 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
10795
10796
10797 @node Debug Session
10798 @subsection Putting it all together
10799
10800 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
10801 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10802 steps.
10803
10804 @enumerate
10805 @item
10806 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
10807 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10808 @display
10809 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10810 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10811 @end display
10812
10813 @item
10814 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10815
10816 @smallexample
10817 set_debug_traps();
10818 breakpoint();
10819 @end smallexample
10820
10821 @item
10822 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10823 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10824
10825 @smallexample
10826 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
10827 @end smallexample
10828
10829 @noindent
10830 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
10831 function in your program, that function is called when
10832 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10833 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10834 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10835
10836 @item
10837 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10838 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10839
10840 @item
10841 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10842 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10843
10844 @item
10845 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10846 @c document that. FIXME.
10847 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10848 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10849
10850 @item
10851 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10852 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10853 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10854 of its pure text.
10855
10856 @item
10857 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
10858 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
10859 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10860 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
10861 TCP or UDP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
10862 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10863 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10864
10865 @smallexample
10866 target remote /dev/ttyb
10867 @end smallexample
10868
10869 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10870 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10871 @code{@var{host}:@var{port}} or @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}.
10872 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10873 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10874
10875 @smallexample
10876 target remote manyfarms:2828
10877 @end smallexample
10878
10879 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10880 your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10881 the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10882 to port 1234 on your local machine:
10883
10884 @smallexample
10885 target remote :1234
10886 @end smallexample
10887 @noindent
10888
10889 Note that the colon is still required here.
10890
10891 @cindex UDP port, @code{target remote}
10892 To use a UDP connection, use an argument of the form
10893 @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}. For example, to connect to UDP port 2828
10894 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10895
10896 @smallexample
10897 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
10898 @end smallexample
10899
10900 When using a UDP connection for remote debugging, you should keep in mind
10901 that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. UDP can silently drop packets on
10902 busy or unreliable networks, which will cause havoc with your debugging
10903 session.
10904
10905 @end enumerate
10906
10907 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10908 step and continue the remote program.
10909
10910 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10911 command.
10912
10913 @cindex interrupting remote programs
10914 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
10915 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10916 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10917 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10918 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10919 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10920
10921 @smallexample
10922 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10923 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10924 @end smallexample
10925
10926 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10927 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10928 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10929 goes back to waiting.
10930
10931
10932 @node Configurations
10933 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
10934
10935 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10936 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10937 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
10938
10939 There are three major categories of configurations: native
10940 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10941 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10942 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10943 are quite different from each other.
10944
10945 @menu
10946 * Native::
10947 * Embedded OS::
10948 * Embedded Processors::
10949 * Architectures::
10950 @end menu
10951
10952 @node Native
10953 @section Native
10954
10955 This section describes details specific to particular native
10956 configurations.
10957
10958 @menu
10959 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
10960 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10961 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
10962 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
10963 @end menu
10964
10965 @node HP-UX
10966 @subsection HP-UX
10967
10968 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10969 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10970 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10971
10972 @node SVR4 Process Information
10973 @subsection SVR4 process information
10974
10975 @kindex /proc
10976 @cindex process image
10977
10978 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10979 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10980 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10981 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10982 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10983 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10984 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10985 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or @sc{gnu}/Linux, for example.
10986
10987 @table @code
10988 @kindex info proc
10989 @item info proc
10990 Summarize available information about the process.
10991
10992 @kindex info proc mappings
10993 @item info proc mappings
10994 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10995 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10996 @ignore
10997 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10998 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10999 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
11000 @kindex info proc times
11001 @item info proc times
11002 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
11003 its children.
11004
11005 @kindex info proc id
11006 @item info proc id
11007 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
11008 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
11009
11010 @kindex info proc status
11011 @item info proc status
11012 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
11013 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
11014 received.
11015
11016 @item info proc all
11017 Show all the above information about the process.
11018 @end ignore
11019 @end table
11020
11021 @node DJGPP Native
11022 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
11023 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
11024 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
11025 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
11026
11027 @sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
11028 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
11029 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
11030 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
11031
11032 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
11033 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
11034 subsection describes those commands.
11035
11036 @table @code
11037 @kindex info dos
11038 @item info dos
11039 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
11040 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11041
11042 @kindex sysinfo
11043 @cindex MS-DOS system info
11044 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
11045 @item info dos sysinfo
11046 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
11047 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
11048 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
11049
11050 @cindex GDT
11051 @cindex LDT
11052 @cindex IDT
11053 @cindex segment descriptor tables
11054 @cindex descriptor tables display
11055 @item info dos gdt
11056 @itemx info dos ldt
11057 @itemx info dos idt
11058 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
11059 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
11060 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
11061 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
11062 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
11063 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
11064 rights.
11065
11066 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
11067 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
11068 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
11069 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
11070 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
11071
11072 @cindex garbled pointers
11073 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
11074 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
11075 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
11076 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
11077 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
11078 debugged program's data segment:
11079
11080 @smallexample
11081 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
11082 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
11083 @end smallexample
11084
11085 @noindent
11086 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
11087 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
11088
11089 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
11090 @item info dos pde
11091 @itemx info dos pte
11092 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
11093 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
11094 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
11095 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
11096 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
11097 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
11098 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
11099 that is currently in use.
11100
11101 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
11102 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
11103 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
11104 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
11105 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
11106 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
11107 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
11108
11109 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
11110 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
11111 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
11112 controller.
11113
11114 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
11115
11116 @cindex physical address from linear address
11117 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
11118 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
11119 address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
11120 appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
11121 accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
11122 example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
11123 the variable @code{i} is stored:
11124
11125 @smallexample
11126 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
11127 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
11128 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
11129 @end smallexample
11130
11131 @noindent
11132 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
11133 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
11134 attributes of that page.
11135
11136 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
11137 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
11138 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
11139 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
11140 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
11141 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
11142
11143 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
11144 transfer buffer:
11145
11146 @smallexample
11147 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
11148 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
11149 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
11150 @end smallexample
11151
11152 @noindent
11153 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
11154 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
11155 this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
11156 mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
11157
11158 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
11159 @end table
11160
11161 @node Cygwin Native
11162 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE executables
11163 @cindex MS Windows debugging
11164 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
11165 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
11166
11167 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
11168 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information. There are various
11169 additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in this subsection. The
11170 subsubsection @pxref{Non-debug DLL symbols} describes working with DLLs
11171 that have no debugging symbols.
11172
11173
11174 @table @code
11175 @kindex info w32
11176 @item info w32
11177 This is a prefix of MS Windows specific commands which print
11178 information about the target system and important OS structures.
11179
11180 @item info w32 selector
11181 This command displays information returned by
11182 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
11183 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
11184 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
11185 Without argument, this command displays information
11186 about the the six segment registers.
11187
11188 @kindex info dll
11189 @item info dll
11190 This is a Cygwin specific alias of info shared.
11191
11192 @kindex dll-symbols
11193 @item dll-symbols
11194 This command loads symbols from a dll similarly to
11195 add-sym command but without the need to specify a base address.
11196
11197 @kindex set new-console
11198 @item set new-console @var{mode}
11199 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
11200 be started in a new console on next start.
11201 If @var{mode} is @code{off}i, the debuggee will
11202 be started in the same console as the debugger.
11203
11204 @kindex show new-console
11205 @item show new-console
11206 Displays whether a new console is used
11207 when the debuggee is started.
11208
11209 @kindex set new-group
11210 @item set new-group @var{mode}
11211 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
11212 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
11213 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
11214 Ctrl-C.
11215
11216 @kindex show new-group
11217 @item show new-group
11218 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
11219
11220 @kindex set debugevents
11221 @item set debugevents
11222 This boolean value adds debug output concerning events seen by the debugger.
11223
11224 @kindex set debugexec
11225 @item set debugexec
11226 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
11227 seen by the debugger.
11228
11229 @kindex set debugexceptions
11230 @item set debugexceptions
11231 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning exception events
11232 seen by the debugger.
11233
11234 @kindex set debugmemory
11235 @item set debugmemory
11236 This boolean value adds debug ouptut concerning memory events
11237 seen by the debugger.
11238
11239 @kindex set shell
11240 @item set shell
11241 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
11242 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
11243
11244 @kindex show shell
11245 @item show shell
11246 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
11247
11248 @end table
11249
11250 @menu
11251 * Non-debug DLL symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11252 @end menu
11253
11254 @node Non-debug DLL symbols
11255 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
11256 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
11257 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
11258
11259 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
11260 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
11261 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
11262 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
11263 information contained in the DLL's export table. This subsubsection
11264 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
11265 ``minimal symbols''.
11266
11267 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
11268 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
11269 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
11270 program run once to completion. It is also possible to force
11271 @value{GDBN} to load a particular DLL before starting the executable ---
11272 see the shared library information in @pxref{Files} or the
11273 @code{dll-symbols} command in @pxref{Cygwin Native}. Currently,
11274 explicitly loading symbols from a DLL with no debugging information will
11275 cause the symbol names to be duplicated in @value{GDBN}'s lookup table,
11276 which may adversely affect symbol lookup performance.
11277
11278 @subsubsection DLL name prefixes
11279
11280 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
11281 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
11282 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
11283 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
11284 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
11285 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
11286 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
11287 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
11288 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
11289
11290 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
11291 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
11292 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
11293 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
11294 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols} (see
11295 @pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
11296
11297 @smallexample
11298 (gdb) info function CreateFileA
11299 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
11300
11301 Non-debugging symbols:
11302 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
11303 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
11304 @end smallexample
11305
11306 @smallexample
11307 (gdb) info function !
11308 All functions matching regular expression "!":
11309
11310 Non-debugging symbols:
11311 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
11312 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
11313 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
11314 [etc...]
11315 @end smallexample
11316
11317 @subsubsection Working with minimal symbols
11318
11319 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
11320 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
11321 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
11322 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
11323 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
11324 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
11325 a function within a DLL without a running program.
11326
11327 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
11328 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
11329 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
11330 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
11331 problem:
11332
11333 @smallexample
11334 (gdb) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
11335 $1 = 268572168
11336 @end smallexample
11337
11338 @smallexample
11339 (gdb) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
11340 0x10021610: "\230y\""
11341 @end smallexample
11342
11343 And two possible solutions:
11344
11345 @smallexample
11346 (gdb) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
11347 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11348 @end smallexample
11349
11350 @smallexample
11351 (gdb) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
11352 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
11353 (gdb) x/x 0x10021608
11354 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
11355 (gdb) x/s 0x0022fd98
11356 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
11357 @end smallexample
11358
11359 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
11360 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
11361 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
11362 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
11363 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
11364
11365 @smallexample
11366 (gdb) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
11367 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
11368 @end smallexample
11369
11370 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
11371 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
11372 safe.
11373
11374 @node Embedded OS
11375 @section Embedded Operating Systems
11376
11377 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
11378 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
11379 architectures.
11380
11381 @menu
11382 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11383 @end menu
11384
11385 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
11386 various real-time operating systems.
11387
11388 @node VxWorks
11389 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
11390
11391 @cindex VxWorks
11392
11393 @table @code
11394
11395 @kindex target vxworks
11396 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
11397 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
11398 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
11399
11400 @end table
11401
11402 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
11403 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
11404
11405 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
11406 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
11407 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11408 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
11409 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
11410 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
11411 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
11412
11413 @table @code
11414 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
11415 @kindex vxworks-timeout
11416 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
11417 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11418 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
11419 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
11420 of a thin network line.
11421 @end table
11422
11423 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
11424 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
11425 procedures.
11426
11427 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
11428 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
11429 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
11430 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
11431 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
11432 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
11433 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
11434 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
11435 manual.
11436 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
11437
11438 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
11439 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11440 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
11441 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
11442
11443 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11444
11445 @smallexample
11446 (vxgdb)
11447 @end smallexample
11448
11449 @menu
11450 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
11451 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
11452 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
11453 @end menu
11454
11455 @node VxWorks Connection
11456 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
11457
11458 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
11459 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
11460
11461 @smallexample
11462 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
11463 @end smallexample
11464
11465 @need 750
11466 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11467
11468 @smallexample
11469 Attaching remote machine across net...
11470 Connected to tt.
11471 @end smallexample
11472
11473 @need 1000
11474 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
11475 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
11476 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
11477 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
11478 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
11479
11480 @smallexample
11481 prog.o: No such file or directory.
11482 @end smallexample
11483
11484 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
11485 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
11486 command again.
11487
11488 @node VxWorks Download
11489 @subsubsection VxWorks download
11490
11491 @cindex download to VxWorks
11492 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
11493 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
11494 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
11495 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
11496 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
11497 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
11498 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
11499 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
11500 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
11501 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
11502 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
11503 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
11504 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
11505 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
11506 program, type this on VxWorks:
11507
11508 @smallexample
11509 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
11510 @end smallexample
11511
11512 @noindent
11513 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11514
11515 @smallexample
11516 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
11517 (vxgdb) load prog.o
11518 @end smallexample
11519
11520 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
11521
11522 @smallexample
11523 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
11524 @end smallexample
11525
11526 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
11527 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
11528 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
11529 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
11530 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
11531 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
11532 table.)
11533
11534 @node VxWorks Attach
11535 @subsubsection Running tasks
11536
11537 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
11538 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
11539 follows:
11540
11541 @smallexample
11542 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
11543 @end smallexample
11544
11545 @noindent
11546 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
11547 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
11548 the time of attachment.
11549
11550 @node Embedded Processors
11551 @section Embedded Processors
11552
11553 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
11554 configurations.
11555
11556
11557 @menu
11558 * ARM:: ARM
11559 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
11560 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
11561 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
11562 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
11563 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
11564 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRisc 1000
11565 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
11566 * PowerPC: PowerPC
11567 * SH:: Hitachi SH
11568 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
11569 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
11570 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
11571 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
11572 @end menu
11573
11574 @node ARM
11575 @subsection ARM
11576
11577 @table @code
11578
11579 @kindex target rdi
11580 @item target rdi @var{dev}
11581 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11582 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11583 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11584
11585 @kindex target rdp
11586 @item target rdp @var{dev}
11587 ARM Demon monitor.
11588
11589 @end table
11590
11591 @node H8/300
11592 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
11593
11594 @table @code
11595
11596 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11597 @item target hms @var{dev}
11598 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11599 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11600 line and the communications speed used.
11601
11602 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11603 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11604 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11605
11606 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11607 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11608 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11609 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11610 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11611
11612 @end table
11613
11614 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11615 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11616 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
11617 @cindex Hitachi SH download
11618 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11619 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11620 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11621 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11622
11623 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11624 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11625
11626 @enumerate
11627 @item
11628 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11629 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11630 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11631 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11632 H8/300, or H8/500.)
11633
11634 @item
11635 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11636 serial device available on your host is the default).
11637
11638 @item
11639 what speed to use over the serial device.
11640 @end enumerate
11641
11642 @menu
11643 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11644 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11645 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11646 @end menu
11647
11648 @node Hitachi Boards
11649 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11650
11651 @c only for Unix hosts
11652 @kindex device
11653 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11654 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11655 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11656 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11657 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11658
11659 @kindex speed
11660 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11661 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11662 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11663 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11664 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11665 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11666
11667 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11668 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11669 use a DOS host,
11670 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11671 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11672 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11673 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11674
11675 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11676 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11677 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11678 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11679
11680 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11681 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11682 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11683 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11684 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11685 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11686 @code{COM2}.
11687
11688 @smallexample
11689 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11690 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11691
11692 Resident portion of MODE loaded
11693
11694 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11695
11696 @end smallexample
11697
11698 @quotation
11699 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11700 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11701 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11702 your development board.
11703 @end quotation
11704
11705 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11706 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11707 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11708 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11709 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11710 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11711 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11712 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11713 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11714 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11715 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11716 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11717 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11718
11719 @smallexample
11720 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11721 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11722 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11723 the conditions.
11724 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11725 for details.
11726 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11727 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
11728 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11729 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11730 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11731 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11732 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11733 @end smallexample
11734
11735 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11736 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11737 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11738 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11739 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11740 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11741
11742 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11743 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11744 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11745
11746 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11747 @itemize @bullet
11748 @item
11749 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11750 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11751
11752 @item
11753 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11754 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11755 to detect program completion.
11756 @end itemize
11757
11758 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11759 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11760
11761 @node Hitachi ICE
11762 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11763
11764 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11765 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11766 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11767 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11768
11769 @table @code
11770 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11771 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11772 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11773 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11774 (for example, @samp{9600}).
11775
11776 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11777 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11778 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11779 @end table
11780
11781 @node Hitachi Special
11782 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11783
11784 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11785
11786 @table @code
11787
11788 @kindex set machine
11789 @kindex show machine
11790 @item set machine h8300
11791 @itemx set machine h8300h
11792 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11793 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11794 to check which variant is currently in effect.
11795
11796 @end table
11797
11798 @node H8/500
11799 @subsection H8/500
11800
11801 @table @code
11802
11803 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
11804 @cindex memory models, H8/500
11805 @item set memory @var{mod}
11806 @itemx show memory
11807 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11808 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11809 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11810 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
11811
11812 @end table
11813
11814 @node M32R/D
11815 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11816
11817 @table @code
11818
11819 @kindex target m32r
11820 @item target m32r @var{dev}
11821 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11822
11823 @end table
11824
11825 @node M68K
11826 @subsection M68k
11827
11828 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11829 target command for the following ROM monitors.
11830
11831 @table @code
11832
11833 @kindex target abug
11834 @item target abug @var{dev}
11835 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11836
11837 @kindex target cpu32bug
11838 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11839 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11840
11841 @kindex target dbug
11842 @item target dbug @var{dev}
11843 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11844
11845 @kindex target est
11846 @item target est @var{dev}
11847 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11848
11849 @kindex target rom68k
11850 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
11851 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11852
11853 @end table
11854
11855 @table @code
11856
11857 @kindex target rombug
11858 @item target rombug @var{dev}
11859 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11860
11861 @end table
11862
11863 @node MIPS Embedded
11864 @subsection MIPS Embedded
11865
11866 @cindex MIPS boards
11867 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11868 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11869 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
11870
11871 @need 1000
11872 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
11873
11874 @table @code
11875 @item target mips @var{port}
11876 @kindex target mips @var{port}
11877 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11878 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11879 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11880 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11881 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11882 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
11883
11884 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11885 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11886 debugger:
11887
11888 @smallexample
11889 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11890 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11891 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11892 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11893 (@value{GDBP}) run
11894 @end smallexample
11895
11896 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11897 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11898 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11899 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11900 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11901
11902 @item target pmon @var{port}
11903 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
11904 PMON ROM monitor.
11905
11906 @item target ddb @var{port}
11907 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
11908 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
11909
11910 @item target lsi @var{port}
11911 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
11912 LSI variant of PMON.
11913
11914 @kindex target r3900
11915 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
11916 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11917
11918 @kindex target array
11919 @item target array @var{dev}
11920 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11921
11922 @end table
11923
11924
11925 @noindent
11926 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11927
11928 @table @code
11929 @item set processor @var{args}
11930 @itemx show processor
11931 @kindex set processor @var{args}
11932 @kindex show processor
11933 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11934 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11935 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11936 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11937 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11938 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11939 @value{GDBN} is using.
11940
11941 @item set mipsfpu double
11942 @itemx set mipsfpu single
11943 @itemx set mipsfpu none
11944 @itemx show mipsfpu
11945 @kindex set mipsfpu
11946 @kindex show mipsfpu
11947 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
11948 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11949 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11950 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11951 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11952 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11953 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11954 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11955 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11956 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11957 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11958 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11959 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11960
11961 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11962 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11963 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11964
11965 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11966 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
11967
11968 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
11969 @itemx show remotedebug
11970 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11971 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11972 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11973 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11974 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11975 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11976 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11977 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11978 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11979 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11980 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11981
11982 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
11983 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11984 @itemx show timeout
11985 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
11986 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11987 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11988 @kindex set timeout
11989 @kindex show timeout
11990 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
11991 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
11992 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11993 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11994 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11995 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11996 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11997 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11998 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11999 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
12000
12001 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
12002 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
12003 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
12004 to run before stopping.
12005 @end table
12006
12007 @node OpenRISC 1000
12008 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
12009 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
12010
12011 @cindex or1k boards
12012 See OR1k Architecture document (@uref{www.opencores.org}) for more information
12013 about platform and commands.
12014
12015 @table @code
12016
12017 @kindex target jtag
12018 @item target jtag jtag://@var{host}:@var{port}
12019
12020 Connects to remote JTAG server.
12021 JTAG remote server can be either an or1ksim or JTAG server,
12022 connected via parallel port to the board.
12023
12024 Example: @code{target jtag jtag://localhost:9999}
12025
12026 @kindex or1ksim
12027 @item or1ksim @var{command}
12028 If connected to @code{or1ksim} OpenRISC 1000 Architectural
12029 Simulator, proprietary commands can be executed.
12030
12031 @kindex info or1k spr
12032 @item info or1k spr
12033 Displays spr groups.
12034
12035 @item info or1k spr @var{group}
12036 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno}
12037 Displays register names in selected group.
12038
12039 @item info or1k spr @var{group} @var{register}
12040 @itemx info or1k spr @var{register}
12041 @itemx info or1k spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno}
12042 @itemx info or1k spr @var{registerno}
12043 Shows information about specified spr register.
12044
12045 @kindex spr
12046 @item spr @var{group} @var{register} @var{value}
12047 @itemx spr @var{register @var{value}}
12048 @itemx spr @var{groupno} @var{registerno @var{value}}
12049 @itemx spr @var{registerno @var{value}}
12050 Writes @var{value} to specified spr register.
12051 @end table
12052
12053 Some implementations of OpenRISC 1000 Architecture also have hardware trace.
12054 It is very similar to @value{GDBN} trace, except it does not interfere with normal
12055 program execution and is thus much faster. Hardware breakpoints/watchpoint
12056 triggers can be set using:
12057 @table @code
12058 @item $LEA/$LDATA
12059 Load effective address/data
12060 @item $SEA/$SDATA
12061 Store effective address/data
12062 @item $AEA/$ADATA
12063 Access effective address ($SEA or $LEA) or data ($SDATA/$LDATA)
12064 @item $FETCH
12065 Fetch data
12066 @end table
12067
12068 When triggered, it can capture low level data, like: @code{PC}, @code{LSEA},
12069 @code{LDATA}, @code{SDATA}, @code{READSPR}, @code{WRITESPR}, @code{INSTR}.
12070
12071 @code{htrace} commands:
12072 @cindex OpenRISC 1000 htrace
12073 @table @code
12074 @kindex hwatch
12075 @item hwatch @var{conditional}
12076 Set hardware watchpoint on combination of Load/Store Effecive Address(es)
12077 or Data. For example:
12078
12079 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12080
12081 @code{hwatch ($LEA == my_var) && ($LDATA < 50) || ($SEA == my_var) && ($SDATA >= 50)}
12082
12083 @kindex htrace info
12084 @item htrace info
12085 Display information about current HW trace configuration.
12086
12087 @kindex htrace trigger
12088 @item htrace trigger @var{conditional}
12089 Set starting criteria for HW trace.
12090
12091 @kindex htrace qualifier
12092 @item htrace qualifier @var{conditional}
12093 Set acquisition qualifier for HW trace.
12094
12095 @kindex htrace stop
12096 @item htrace stop @var{conditional}
12097 Set HW trace stopping criteria.
12098
12099 @kindex htrace record
12100 @item htrace record [@var{data}]*
12101 Selects the data to be recorded, when qualifier is met and HW trace was
12102 triggered.
12103
12104 @kindex htrace enable
12105 @item htrace enable
12106 @kindex htrace disable
12107 @itemx htrace disable
12108 Enables/disables the HW trace.
12109
12110 @kindex htrace rewind
12111 @item htrace rewind [@var{filename}]
12112 Clears currently recorded trace data.
12113
12114 If filename is specified, new trace file is made and any newly collected data
12115 will be written there.
12116
12117 @kindex htrace print
12118 @item htrace print [@var{start} [@var{len}]]
12119 Prints trace buffer, using current record configuration.
12120
12121 @kindex htrace mode continuous
12122 @item htrace mode continuous
12123 Set continuous trace mode.
12124
12125 @kindex htrace mode suspend
12126 @item htrace mode suspend
12127 Set suspend trace mode.
12128
12129 @end table
12130
12131 @node PowerPC
12132 @subsection PowerPC
12133
12134 @table @code
12135
12136 @kindex target dink32
12137 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
12138 DINK32 ROM monitor.
12139
12140 @kindex target ppcbug
12141 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
12142 @kindex target ppcbug1
12143 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
12144 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
12145
12146 @kindex target sds
12147 @item target sds @var{dev}
12148 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
12149
12150 @end table
12151
12152 @node PA
12153 @subsection HP PA Embedded
12154
12155 @table @code
12156
12157 @kindex target op50n
12158 @item target op50n @var{dev}
12159 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
12160
12161 @kindex target w89k
12162 @item target w89k @var{dev}
12163 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
12164
12165 @end table
12166
12167 @node SH
12168 @subsection Hitachi SH
12169
12170 @table @code
12171
12172 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12173 @item target hms @var{dev}
12174 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
12175 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
12176 the communications speed used.
12177
12178 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
12179 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
12180 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
12181
12182 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
12183 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
12184 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
12185 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
12186 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
12187
12188 @end table
12189
12190 @node Sparclet
12191 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
12192
12193 @cindex Sparclet
12194
12195 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
12196 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
12197 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
12198 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
12199 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
12200
12201 @table @code
12202 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
12203 @kindex remotetimeout
12204 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
12205 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
12206 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
12207 @end table
12208
12209 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
12210 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
12211 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
12212 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
12213 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
12214
12215 @smallexample
12216 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
12217 @end smallexample
12218
12219 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
12220
12221 @smallexample
12222 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
12223 @end smallexample
12224
12225 @cindex running, on Sparclet
12226 Once you have set
12227 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
12228 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
12229 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
12230
12231 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
12232
12233 @smallexample
12234 (gdbslet)
12235 @end smallexample
12236
12237 @menu
12238 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
12239 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
12240 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
12241 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
12242 @end menu
12243
12244 @node Sparclet File
12245 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
12246
12247 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
12248
12249 @smallexample
12250 (gdbslet) file prog
12251 @end smallexample
12252
12253 @need 1000
12254 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
12255 @value{GDBN} locates
12256 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
12257 path.
12258 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
12259 files will be searched as well.
12260 @value{GDBN} locates
12261 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
12262 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
12263 If it fails
12264 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
12265
12266 @smallexample
12267 prog: No such file or directory.
12268 @end smallexample
12269
12270 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
12271 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
12272 @code{target} command again.
12273
12274 @node Sparclet Connection
12275 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
12276
12277 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
12278 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
12279
12280 @smallexample
12281 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
12282 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
12283 main () at ../prog.c:3
12284 @end smallexample
12285
12286 @need 750
12287 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
12288
12289 @smallexample
12290 Connected to ttya.
12291 @end smallexample
12292
12293 @node Sparclet Download
12294 @subsubsection Sparclet download
12295
12296 @cindex download to Sparclet
12297 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
12298 you can use the @value{GDBN}
12299 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
12300 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
12301 command.
12302 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
12303 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
12304 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
12305 of each of the file's sections.
12306 For instance, if the program
12307 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
12308 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
12309
12310 @smallexample
12311 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
12312 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
12313 @end smallexample
12314
12315 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
12316 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
12317 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
12318
12319 @node Sparclet Execution
12320 @subsubsection Running and debugging
12321
12322 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
12323 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
12324 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
12325 manual for the list of commands.
12326
12327 @smallexample
12328 (gdbslet) b main
12329 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
12330 (gdbslet) run
12331 Starting program: prog
12332 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
12333 3 char *symarg = 0;
12334 (gdbslet) step
12335 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
12336 (gdbslet)
12337 @end smallexample
12338
12339 @node Sparclite
12340 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
12341
12342 @table @code
12343
12344 @kindex target sparclite
12345 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
12346 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
12347 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
12348 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
12349 remote protocol.
12350
12351 @end table
12352
12353 @node ST2000
12354 @subsection Tandem ST2000
12355
12356 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
12357 STDBUG protocol.
12358
12359 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
12360 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
12361
12362 @smallexample
12363 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
12364 @end smallexample
12365
12366 @noindent
12367 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
12368 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
12369 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
12370 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
12371 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
12372
12373 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
12374 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
12375 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
12376 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
12377 available on your host computer.
12378 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
12379 @c basically hearsay.
12380
12381 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
12382 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
12383 environment:
12384
12385 @table @code
12386 @item st2000 @var{command}
12387 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
12388 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
12389 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
12390 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
12391 manual for available commands.
12392
12393 @item connect
12394 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
12395 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
12396 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
12397 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
12398 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
12399 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
12400 @end table
12401
12402 @node Z8000
12403 @subsection Zilog Z8000
12404
12405 @cindex Z8000
12406 @cindex simulator, Z8000
12407 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
12408
12409 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
12410 a Z8000 simulator.
12411
12412 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
12413 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
12414 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
12415 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
12416
12417 @table @code
12418 @item target sim @var{args}
12419 @kindex sim
12420 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
12421 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
12422 options, specify them via @var{args}.
12423 @end table
12424
12425 @noindent
12426 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
12427 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
12428 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
12429 to run your program, and so on.
12430
12431 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
12432 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
12433 additional items of information as specially named registers:
12434
12435 @table @code
12436
12437 @item cycles
12438 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
12439
12440 @item insts
12441 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
12442
12443 @item time
12444 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
12445
12446 @end table
12447
12448 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12449 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12450 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12451 simulated clock ticks.
12452
12453 @node Architectures
12454 @section Architectures
12455
12456 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12457 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
12458
12459 @menu
12460 * A29K::
12461 * Alpha::
12462 * MIPS::
12463 @end menu
12464
12465 @node A29K
12466 @subsection A29K
12467
12468 @table @code
12469
12470 @kindex set rstack_high_address
12471 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
12472 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
12473 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12474 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12475 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12476 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12477 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12478 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12479 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12480 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12481 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12482 hexadecimal.
12483
12484 @kindex show rstack_high_address
12485 @item show rstack_high_address
12486 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12487 processors.
12488
12489 @end table
12490
12491 @node Alpha
12492 @subsection Alpha
12493
12494 See the following section.
12495
12496 @node MIPS
12497 @subsection MIPS
12498
12499 @cindex stack on Alpha
12500 @cindex stack on MIPS
12501 @cindex Alpha stack
12502 @cindex MIPS stack
12503 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12504 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12505 find the beginning of a function.
12506
12507 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12508 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12509 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12510 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12511 commands:
12512
12513 @table @code
12514 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12515 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12516 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12517 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12518 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12519 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12520 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
12521
12522 @item show heuristic-fence-post
12523 Display the current limit.
12524 @end table
12525
12526 @noindent
12527 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12528 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
12529
12530
12531 @node Controlling GDB
12532 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12533
12534 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12535 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12536 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12537 described here.
12538
12539 @menu
12540 * Prompt:: Prompt
12541 * Editing:: Command editing
12542 * History:: Command history
12543 * Screen Size:: Screen size
12544 * Numbers:: Numbers
12545 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
12546 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12547 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12548 @end menu
12549
12550 @node Prompt
12551 @section Prompt
12552
12553 @cindex prompt
12554
12555 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12556 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12557 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12558 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12559 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12560 which one you are talking to.
12561
12562 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12563 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12564 or a prompt that does not.
12565
12566 @table @code
12567 @kindex set prompt
12568 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12569 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
12570
12571 @kindex show prompt
12572 @item show prompt
12573 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
12574 @end table
12575
12576 @node Editing
12577 @section Command editing
12578 @cindex readline
12579 @cindex command line editing
12580
12581 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12582 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12583 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12584 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12585 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12586 debugging sessions.
12587
12588 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12589 command @code{set}.
12590
12591 @table @code
12592 @kindex set editing
12593 @cindex editing
12594 @item set editing
12595 @itemx set editing on
12596 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
12597
12598 @item set editing off
12599 Disable command line editing.
12600
12601 @kindex show editing
12602 @item show editing
12603 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
12604 @end table
12605
12606 @node History
12607 @section Command history
12608
12609 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12610 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12611 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12612 history facility.
12613
12614 @table @code
12615 @cindex history substitution
12616 @cindex history file
12617 @kindex set history filename
12618 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
12619 @item set history filename @var{fname}
12620 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12621 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12622 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12623 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12624 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12625 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12626 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12627 is not set.
12628
12629 @cindex history save
12630 @kindex set history save
12631 @item set history save
12632 @itemx set history save on
12633 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12634 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
12635
12636 @item set history save off
12637 Stop recording command history in a file.
12638
12639 @cindex history size
12640 @kindex set history size
12641 @item set history size @var{size}
12642 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12643 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12644 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
12645 @end table
12646
12647 @cindex history expansion
12648 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12649 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12650 @xref{Event Designators}.
12651 @end ifset
12652
12653 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12654 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12655 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12656 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12657 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12658 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12659 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12660
12661 The commands to control history expansion are:
12662
12663 @table @code
12664 @kindex set history expansion
12665 @item set history expansion on
12666 @itemx set history expansion
12667 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
12668
12669 @item set history expansion off
12670 Disable history expansion.
12671
12672 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12673 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12674 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12675 @ifset have-readline-appendices
12676 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
12677 @end ifset
12678
12679 @c @group
12680 @kindex show history
12681 @item show history
12682 @itemx show history filename
12683 @itemx show history save
12684 @itemx show history size
12685 @itemx show history expansion
12686 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12687 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12688 @c @end group
12689 @end table
12690
12691 @table @code
12692 @kindex shows
12693 @item show commands
12694 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
12695
12696 @item show commands @var{n}
12697 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12698
12699 @item show commands +
12700 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
12701 @end table
12702
12703 @node Screen Size
12704 @section Screen size
12705 @cindex size of screen
12706 @cindex pauses in output
12707
12708 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12709 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12710 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12711 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12712 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12713 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12714 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12715 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12716
12717 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12718 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12719 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12720 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12721 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12722 width} commands:
12723
12724 @table @code
12725 @kindex set height
12726 @kindex set width
12727 @kindex show width
12728 @kindex show height
12729 @item set height @var{lpp}
12730 @itemx show height
12731 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
12732 @itemx show width
12733 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12734 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12735 commands display the current settings.
12736
12737 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12738 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12739 file or to an editor buffer.
12740
12741 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12742 from wrapping its output.
12743 @end table
12744
12745 @node Numbers
12746 @section Numbers
12747 @cindex number representation
12748 @cindex entering numbers
12749
12750 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12751 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12752 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12753 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12754 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12755 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12756 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12757 radix} command.
12758
12759 @table @code
12760 @kindex set input-radix
12761 @item set input-radix @var{base}
12762 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12763 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12764 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12765 example, any of
12766
12767 @smallexample
12768 set radix 012
12769 set radix 10.
12770 set radix 0xa
12771 @end smallexample
12772
12773 @noindent
12774 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12775 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
12776
12777 @kindex set output-radix
12778 @item set output-radix @var{base}
12779 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12780 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12781 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
12782
12783 @kindex show input-radix
12784 @item show input-radix
12785 Display the current default base for numeric input.
12786
12787 @kindex show output-radix
12788 @item show output-radix
12789 Display the current default base for numeric display.
12790 @end table
12791
12792 @node ABI
12793 @section Configuring the current ABI
12794
12795 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
12796 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
12797 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
12798 current ABI.
12799
12800 @cindex OS ABI
12801 @kindex set osabi
12802 @kindex show osabi
12803
12804 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
12805 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
12806 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
12807 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
12808 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
12809 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
12810 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
12811 platform provides.
12812
12813 @table @code
12814 @item show osabi
12815 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
12816
12817 @item set osabi
12818 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
12819
12820 @item set osabi @var{abi}
12821 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
12822 @end table
12823
12824 @cindex float promotion
12825 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
12826
12827 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
12828 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
12829 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
12830 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
12831 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
12832 @code{double} and then passed.
12833
12834 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
12835 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
12836 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
12837
12838 @table @code
12839 @item set coerce-float-to-double
12840 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
12841 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
12842 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
12843
12844 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
12845 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
12846 functions.
12847 @end table
12848
12849 @kindex set cp-abi
12850 @kindex show cp-abi
12851 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
12852 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
12853 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
12854 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
12855 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
12856 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
12857 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
12858 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
12859 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
12860 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
12861 ``auto''.
12862
12863 @table @code
12864 @item show cp-abi
12865 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
12866
12867 @item set cp-abi
12868 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
12869
12870 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
12871 @itemx set cp-abi auto
12872 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
12873 @end table
12874
12875 @node Messages/Warnings
12876 @section Optional warnings and messages
12877
12878 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12879 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12880 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12881 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
12882
12883 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12884 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12885 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
12886
12887 @table @code
12888 @kindex set verbose
12889 @item set verbose on
12890 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12891
12892 @item set verbose off
12893 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
12894
12895 @kindex show verbose
12896 @item show verbose
12897 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12898 @end table
12899
12900 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12901 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12902 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12903 symbol files}).
12904
12905 @table @code
12906
12907 @kindex set complaints
12908 @item set complaints @var{limit}
12909 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12910 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12911 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12912 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
12913
12914 @kindex show complaints
12915 @item show complaints
12916 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
12917
12918 @end table
12919
12920 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12921 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12922 you try to run a program which is already running:
12923
12924 @smallexample
12925 (@value{GDBP}) run
12926 The program being debugged has been started already.
12927 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
12928 @end smallexample
12929
12930 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12931 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
12932
12933 @table @code
12934
12935 @kindex set confirm
12936 @cindex flinching
12937 @cindex confirmation
12938 @cindex stupid questions
12939 @item set confirm off
12940 Disables confirmation requests.
12941
12942 @item set confirm on
12943 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
12944
12945 @kindex show confirm
12946 @item show confirm
12947 Displays state of confirmation requests.
12948
12949 @end table
12950
12951 @node Debugging Output
12952 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
12953 @table @code
12954 @kindex set debug arch
12955 @item set debug arch
12956 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12957 @kindex show debug arch
12958 @item show debug arch
12959 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12960 @kindex set debug event
12961 @item set debug event
12962 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12963 default is off.
12964 @kindex show debug event
12965 @item show debug event
12966 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12967 info.
12968 @kindex set debug expression
12969 @item set debug expression
12970 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12971 default is off.
12972 @kindex show debug expression
12973 @item show debug expression
12974 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12975 debugging info.
12976 @kindex set debug frame
12977 @item set debug frame
12978 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
12979 default is off.
12980 @kindex show debug frame
12981 @item show debug frame
12982 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
12983 info.
12984 @kindex set debug overload
12985 @item set debug overload
12986 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12987 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12988 is off.
12989 @kindex show debug overload
12990 @item show debug overload
12991 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12992 debugging info.
12993 @kindex set debug remote
12994 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12995 @cindex serial connections, debugging
12996 @item set debug remote
12997 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12998 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12999 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
13000 @kindex show debug remote
13001 @item show debug remote
13002 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
13003 @kindex set debug serial
13004 @item set debug serial
13005 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
13006 default is off.
13007 @kindex show debug serial
13008 @item show debug serial
13009 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
13010 info.
13011 @kindex set debug target
13012 @item set debug target
13013 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
13014 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
13015 default is off.
13016 @kindex show debug target
13017 @item show debug target
13018 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
13019 info.
13020 @kindex set debug varobj
13021 @item set debug varobj
13022 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
13023 info. The default is off.
13024 @kindex show debug varobj
13025 @item show debug varobj
13026 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
13027 debugging info.
13028 @end table
13029
13030 @node Sequences
13031 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
13032
13033 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
13034 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
13035 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
13036 files.
13037
13038 @menu
13039 * Define:: User-defined commands
13040 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
13041 * Command Files:: Command files
13042 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
13043 @end menu
13044
13045 @node Define
13046 @section User-defined commands
13047
13048 @cindex user-defined command
13049 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
13050 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
13051 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
13052 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
13053 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
13054
13055 @smallexample
13056 define adder
13057 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
13058 @end smallexample
13059
13060 @noindent
13061 To execute the command use:
13062
13063 @smallexample
13064 adder 1 2 3
13065 @end smallexample
13066
13067 @noindent
13068 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
13069 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
13070 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
13071 functions calls.
13072
13073 @table @code
13074
13075 @kindex define
13076 @item define @var{commandname}
13077 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
13078 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
13079
13080 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
13081 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
13082 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13083
13084 @kindex if
13085 @kindex else
13086 @item if
13087 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
13088 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
13089 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
13090 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
13091 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
13092 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
13093
13094 @kindex while
13095 @item while
13096 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
13097 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
13098 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
13099 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
13100 evaluates to true.
13101
13102 @kindex document
13103 @item document @var{commandname}
13104 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
13105 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
13106 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
13107 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
13108 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
13109 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
13110
13111 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
13112 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
13113 does not change the documentation.
13114
13115 @kindex help user-defined
13116 @item help user-defined
13117 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
13118 (if any) for each.
13119
13120 @kindex show user
13121 @item show user
13122 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
13123 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
13124 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
13125 definitions for all user-defined commands.
13126
13127 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
13128 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
13129 @item show max-user-call-depth
13130 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
13131 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
13132 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before GDB suspects an
13133 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
13134
13135 @end table
13136
13137 When user-defined commands are executed, the
13138 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
13139 stops execution of the user-defined command.
13140
13141 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
13142 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
13143 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
13144 messages when used in a user-defined command.
13145
13146 @node Hooks
13147 @section User-defined command hooks
13148 @cindex command hooks
13149 @cindex hooks, for commands
13150 @cindex hooks, pre-command
13151
13152 @kindex hook
13153 @kindex hook-
13154 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
13155 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
13156 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
13157 before that command.
13158
13159 @cindex hooks, post-command
13160 @kindex hookpost
13161 @kindex hookpost-
13162 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
13163 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
13164 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
13165 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
13166 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
13167
13168 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
13169 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
13170
13171 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
13172 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
13173
13174 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
13175 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
13176 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
13177 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
13178 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
13179
13180 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
13181 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
13182 you could define:
13183
13184 @smallexample
13185 define hook-stop
13186 handle SIGALRM nopass
13187 end
13188
13189 define hook-run
13190 handle SIGALRM pass
13191 end
13192
13193 define hook-continue
13194 handle SIGLARM pass
13195 end
13196 @end smallexample
13197
13198 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
13199 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
13200 you could define:
13201
13202 @smallexample
13203 define hook-echo
13204 echo <<<---
13205 end
13206
13207 define hookpost-echo
13208 echo --->>>\n
13209 end
13210
13211 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
13212 <<<---Hello World--->>>
13213 (@value{GDBP})
13214
13215 @end smallexample
13216
13217 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
13218 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
13219 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
13220 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
13221 @c or not?
13222 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
13223 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
13224 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
13225
13226 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
13227 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
13228
13229 @node Command Files
13230 @section Command files
13231
13232 @cindex command files
13233 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
13234 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
13235 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
13236 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
13237
13238 @cindex init file
13239 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
13240 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
13241 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
13242 @dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
13243 port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
13244 limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
13245 During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
13246
13247 @enumerate
13248 @item
13249 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
13250 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
13251 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
13252
13253 @item
13254 Processes command line options and operands.
13255
13256 @item
13257 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
13258
13259 @item
13260 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
13261 @end enumerate
13262
13263 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
13264 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
13265 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
13266 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
13267
13268 @cindex init file name
13269 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
13270 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
13271 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
13272 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
13273 environments with special init file names:
13274
13275 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
13276 @itemize @bullet
13277 @item
13278 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
13279
13280 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
13281 @item
13282 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
13283
13284 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
13285 @item
13286 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
13287 @end itemize
13288
13289 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
13290 @code{source} command:
13291
13292 @table @code
13293 @kindex source
13294 @item source @var{filename}
13295 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
13296 @end table
13297
13298 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
13299 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
13300 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
13301
13302 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
13303 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
13304 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
13305 when called from command files.
13306
13307 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
13308 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
13309 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
13310 not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
13311 the next command.
13312
13313 @smallexample
13314 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
13315 @end smallexample
13316
13317 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
13318 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
13319 would be directed to @file{log}.
13320
13321 @node Output
13322 @section Commands for controlled output
13323
13324 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
13325 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
13326 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
13327 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
13328 want.
13329
13330 @table @code
13331 @kindex echo
13332 @item echo @var{text}
13333 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
13334 @c because it is not in ANSI.
13335 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
13336 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
13337 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
13338 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
13339 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
13340 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
13341 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
13342 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
13343 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
13344
13345 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
13346 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
13347
13348 @smallexample
13349 echo This is some text\n\
13350 which is continued\n\
13351 onto several lines.\n
13352 @end smallexample
13353
13354 produces the same output as
13355
13356 @smallexample
13357 echo This is some text\n
13358 echo which is continued\n
13359 echo onto several lines.\n
13360 @end smallexample
13361
13362 @kindex output
13363 @item output @var{expression}
13364 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
13365 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
13366 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
13367 on expressions.
13368
13369 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
13370 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
13371 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
13372 formats}, for more information.
13373
13374 @kindex printf
13375 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
13376 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
13377 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
13378 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
13379 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
13380 subroutine
13381 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
13382 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
13383 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
13384 @c supported.
13385
13386 @smallexample
13387 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
13388 @end smallexample
13389
13390 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
13391
13392 @smallexample
13393 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
13394 @end smallexample
13395
13396 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
13397 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
13398 letter.
13399 @end table
13400
13401 @node Interpreters
13402 @chapter Command Interpreters
13403 @cindex command interpreters
13404
13405 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
13406 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
13407 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
13408
13409 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
13410 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
13411 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
13412 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
13413
13414 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
13415 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
13416 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
13417 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
13418
13419 @table @code
13420 @item console
13421 @cindex console interpreter
13422 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
13423 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
13424 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
13425
13426 @item mi
13427 @cindex mi interpreter
13428 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
13429 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
13430 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
13431 Interface}.
13432
13433 @item mi2
13434 @cindex mi2 interpreter
13435 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
13436
13437 @item mi1
13438 @cindex mi1 interpreter
13439 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
13440
13441 @end table
13442
13443 @cindex invoke another interpreter
13444 The interpreter being used by @value{GDBN} may not be dynamically
13445 switched at runtime. Although possible, this could lead to a very
13446 precarious situation. Consider an IDE using @sc{gdb/mi}. If a user
13447 enters the command "interpreter-set console" in a console view,
13448 @value{GDBN} would switch to using the console interpreter, rendering
13449 the IDE inoperable!
13450
13451 @kindex interpreter-exec
13452 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, you may execute
13453 commands in any interpreter from the current interpreter using the appropriate
13454 command. If you are running the console interpreter, simply use the
13455 @code{interpreter-exec} command:
13456
13457 @smallexample
13458 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
13459 @end smallexample
13460
13461 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
13462 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
13463
13464 @node TUI
13465 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
13466 @cindex TUI
13467
13468 @menu
13469 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
13470 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
13471 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
13472 * TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
13473 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
13474 @end menu
13475
13476 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
13477 is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
13478 to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
13479 and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
13480 The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
13481 with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
13482
13483 @node TUI Overview
13484 @section TUI overview
13485
13486 The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
13487 @value{GDBN} runs:
13488
13489 @itemize @bullet
13490 @item
13491 A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
13492 windows on the terminal.
13493
13494 @item
13495 A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
13496 the TUI.
13497 @end itemize
13498
13499 In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
13500 on the terminal:
13501
13502 @table @emph
13503 @item command
13504 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
13505 prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
13506 managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
13507 window is always visible.
13508
13509 @item source
13510 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
13511 line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
13512
13513 @item assembly
13514 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
13515
13516 @item register
13517 This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
13518 a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
13519 changed are highlighted.
13520
13521 @end table
13522
13523 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
13524 by highlighting the current line and marking them with the @samp{>} marker.
13525 Breakpoints are also indicated with two markers. A first one
13526 indicates the breakpoint type:
13527
13528 @table @code
13529 @item B
13530 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13531
13532 @item b
13533 Breakpoint which was never hit.
13534
13535 @item H
13536 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
13537
13538 @item h
13539 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
13540
13541 @end table
13542
13543 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
13544
13545 @table @code
13546 @item +
13547 Breakpoint is enabled.
13548
13549 @item -
13550 Breakpoint is disabled.
13551
13552 @end table
13553
13554 The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
13555 and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
13556 changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
13557 These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
13558 layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
13559 The following layouts are available:
13560
13561 @itemize @bullet
13562 @item
13563 source
13564
13565 @item
13566 assembly
13567
13568 @item
13569 source and assembly
13570
13571 @item
13572 source and registers
13573
13574 @item
13575 assembly and registers
13576
13577 @end itemize
13578
13579 On top of the command window a status line gives various information
13580 concerning the current process begin debugged. The status line is
13581 updated when the information it shows changes. The following fields
13582 are displayed:
13583
13584 @table @emph
13585 @item target
13586 Indicates the current gdb target
13587 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
13588
13589 @item process
13590 Gives information about the current process or thread number.
13591 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
13592
13593 @item function
13594 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
13595 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
13596 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter
13597 the string @code{??} is displayed.
13598
13599 @item line
13600 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
13601 When the current line number is not known the string @code{??} is displayed.
13602
13603 @item pc
13604 Indicates the current program counter address.
13605
13606 @end table
13607
13608 @node TUI Keys
13609 @section TUI Key Bindings
13610 @cindex TUI key bindings
13611
13612 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
13613 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
13614 They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
13615 directly on the TUI layout and windows. The TUI also provides
13616 a @emph{SingleKey} keymap which binds several keys directly to
13617 @value{GDBN} commands. The following key bindings
13618 are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
13619
13620 @table @kbd
13621 @kindex C-x C-a
13622 @item C-x C-a
13623 @kindex C-x a
13624 @itemx C-x a
13625 @kindex C-x A
13626 @itemx C-x A
13627 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
13628 the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
13629 its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
13630 mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
13631 The screen is then refreshed.
13632
13633 @kindex C-x 1
13634 @item C-x 1
13635 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
13636 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
13637 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
13638
13639 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
13640
13641 @kindex C-x 2
13642 @item C-x 2
13643 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
13644 layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
13645 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
13646 previous layout and the new one.
13647
13648 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
13649
13650 @kindex C-x s
13651 @item C-x s
13652 Use the TUI @emph{SingleKey} keymap that binds single key to gdb commands
13653 (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
13654
13655 @end table
13656
13657 The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
13658
13659 @table @key
13660 @kindex PgUp
13661 @item PgUp
13662 Scroll the active window one page up.
13663
13664 @kindex PgDn
13665 @item PgDn
13666 Scroll the active window one page down.
13667
13668 @kindex Up
13669 @item Up
13670 Scroll the active window one line up.
13671
13672 @kindex Down
13673 @item Down
13674 Scroll the active window one line down.
13675
13676 @kindex Left
13677 @item Left
13678 Scroll the active window one column left.
13679
13680 @kindex Right
13681 @item Right
13682 Scroll the active window one column right.
13683
13684 @kindex C-L
13685 @item C-L
13686 Refresh the screen.
13687
13688 @end table
13689
13690 In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13691 for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13692 necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13693 @key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13694
13695 @node TUI Single Key Mode
13696 @section TUI Single Key Mode
13697 @cindex TUI single key mode
13698
13699 The TUI provides a @emph{SingleKey} mode in which it installs a particular
13700 key binding in the readline keymaps to connect single keys to
13701 some gdb commands.
13702
13703 @table @kbd
13704 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13705 @item c
13706 continue
13707
13708 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13709 @item d
13710 down
13711
13712 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13713 @item f
13714 finish
13715
13716 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13717 @item n
13718 next
13719
13720 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13721 @item q
13722 exit the @emph{SingleKey} mode.
13723
13724 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13725 @item r
13726 run
13727
13728 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13729 @item s
13730 step
13731
13732 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13733 @item u
13734 up
13735
13736 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13737 @item v
13738 info locals
13739
13740 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
13741 @item w
13742 where
13743
13744 @end table
13745
13746 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
13747 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
13748 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
13749 with the TUI @emph{SingleKey} mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
13750 @emph{SingleKey} mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
13751 this mode is by hitting @key{q} or @samp{@key{C-x} @key{s}}.
13752
13753
13754 @node TUI Commands
13755 @section TUI specific commands
13756 @cindex TUI commands
13757
13758 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13759 These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13760 the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13761 is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13762 in the TUI mode.
13763
13764 @table @code
13765 @item info win
13766 @kindex info win
13767 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
13768
13769 @item layout next
13770 @kindex layout next
13771 Display the next layout.
13772
13773 @item layout prev
13774 @kindex layout prev
13775 Display the previous layout.
13776
13777 @item layout src
13778 @kindex layout src
13779 Display the source window only.
13780
13781 @item layout asm
13782 @kindex layout asm
13783 Display the assembly window only.
13784
13785 @item layout split
13786 @kindex layout split
13787 Display the source and assembly window.
13788
13789 @item layout regs
13790 @kindex layout regs
13791 Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13792
13793 @item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13794 @kindex focus
13795 Set the focus to the named window.
13796 This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13797 can be affected to another window.
13798
13799 @item refresh
13800 @kindex refresh
13801 Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
13802
13803 @item update
13804 @kindex update
13805 Update the source window and the current execution point.
13806
13807 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13808 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13809 @kindex winheight
13810 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13811 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13812 decrease it.
13813
13814 @end table
13815
13816 @node TUI Configuration
13817 @section TUI configuration variables
13818 @cindex TUI configuration variables
13819
13820 The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13821 appearance of windows on the terminal.
13822
13823 @table @code
13824 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13825 @kindex set tui border-kind
13826 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13827 The possible values are the following:
13828 @table @code
13829 @item space
13830 Use a space character to draw the border.
13831
13832 @item ascii
13833 Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
13834
13835 @item acs
13836 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13837 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
13838
13839 @end table
13840
13841 @item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13842 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
13843 Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13844 The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13845 @code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
13846
13847 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13848 @kindex set tui border-mode
13849 Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13850 The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13851 @table @code
13852 @item normal
13853 Use normal attributes to display the border.
13854
13855 @item standout
13856 Use standout mode.
13857
13858 @item reverse
13859 Use reverse video mode.
13860
13861 @item half
13862 Use half bright mode.
13863
13864 @item half-standout
13865 Use half bright and standout mode.
13866
13867 @item bold
13868 Use extra bright or bold mode.
13869
13870 @item bold-standout
13871 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
13872
13873 @end table
13874
13875 @end table
13876
13877 @node Emacs
13878 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
13879
13880 @cindex Emacs
13881 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13882 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13883 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13884 @value{GDBN}.
13885
13886 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13887 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13888 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13889 created Emacs buffer.
13890 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
13891
13892 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13893 things:
13894
13895 @itemize @bullet
13896 @item
13897 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13898 @end itemize
13899
13900 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13901 and output done by the program you are debugging.
13902
13903 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13904 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13905 in this way.
13906
13907 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13908 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13909 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13910 stop.
13911
13912 @itemize @bullet
13913 @item
13914 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13915 @end itemize
13916
13917 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13918 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13919 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13920 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13921 and the source.
13922
13923 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13924 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
13925
13926 @quotation
13927 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13928 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13929 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13930 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13931 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13932 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13933 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13934 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13935 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13936 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
13937
13938 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13939 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13940 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13941 @end quotation
13942
13943 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13944 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13945 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13946 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13947
13948 @smallexample
13949 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13950 @end smallexample
13951
13952 @noindent
13953 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13954 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13955 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13956
13957 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13958 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
13959
13960 @table @kbd
13961 @item C-h m
13962 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
13963
13964 @item M-s
13965 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13966 update the display window to show the current file and location.
13967
13968 @item M-n
13969 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13970 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13971 to show the current file and location.
13972
13973 @item M-i
13974 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13975 display window accordingly.
13976
13977 @item M-x gdb-nexti
13978 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13979 display window accordingly.
13980
13981 @item C-c C-f
13982 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13983 @code{finish} command.
13984
13985 @item M-c
13986 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13987 command.
13988
13989 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
13990
13991 @item M-u
13992 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13993 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13994 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
13995
13996 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
13997
13998 @item M-d
13999 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
14000 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
14001
14002 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
14003
14004 @item C-x &
14005 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
14006 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
14007 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
14008 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
14009 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
14010
14011 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
14012 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
14013 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
14014 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
14015 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
14016 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
14017 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
14018 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
14019 @end table
14020
14021 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
14022 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
14023
14024 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
14025 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
14026 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
14027 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
14028 frame.
14029
14030 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
14031 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
14032 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
14033 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
14034 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
14035 to correspond properly with the code.
14036
14037 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
14038 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
14039 @ignore
14040 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
14041 @kindex Epoch
14042 @kindex inspect
14043
14044 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
14045 called the @code{epoch}
14046 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
14047 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
14048 each value is printed in its own window.
14049 @end ignore
14050
14051 @include annotate.texi
14052 @include gdbmi.texinfo
14053
14054 @node GDB Bugs
14055 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
14056 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
14057 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
14058
14059 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
14060
14061 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
14062 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
14063 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
14064 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
14065
14066 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
14067 information that enables us to fix the bug.
14068
14069 @menu
14070 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
14071 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
14072 @end menu
14073
14074 @node Bug Criteria
14075 @section Have you found a bug?
14076 @cindex bug criteria
14077
14078 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
14079
14080 @itemize @bullet
14081 @cindex fatal signal
14082 @cindex debugger crash
14083 @cindex crash of debugger
14084 @item
14085 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
14086 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
14087
14088 @cindex error on valid input
14089 @item
14090 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
14091 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
14092 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
14093
14094 @cindex invalid input
14095 @item
14096 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
14097 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
14098 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
14099 for traditional practice''.
14100
14101 @item
14102 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
14103 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
14104 @end itemize
14105
14106 @node Bug Reporting
14107 @section How to report bugs
14108 @cindex bug reports
14109 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
14110
14111 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
14112 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
14113 contact that organization first.
14114
14115 You can find contact information for many support companies and
14116 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
14117 distribution.
14118 @c should add a web page ref...
14119
14120 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
14121 @value{GDBN}. The prefered method is to submit them directly using
14122 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
14123 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
14124 be used.
14125
14126 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
14127 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
14128 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
14129 @samp{bug-gdb}.
14130
14131 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
14132 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
14133 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
14134 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
14135 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
14136 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
14137 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
14138 bug reports to the mailing list.
14139
14140 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
14141 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
14142 fact or leave it out, state it!
14143
14144 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
14145 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
14146 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
14147 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
14148 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
14149 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
14150 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
14151 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
14152 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
14153
14154 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
14155 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
14156 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
14157 self-contained.
14158
14159 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
14160 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
14161 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
14162 bugs properly.
14163
14164 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
14165
14166 @itemize @bullet
14167 @item
14168 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
14169 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
14170 version}.
14171
14172 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
14173 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
14174
14175 @item
14176 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
14177 version number.
14178
14179 @item
14180 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
14181 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
14182
14183 @item
14184 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
14185 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
14186 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
14187 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
14188 compilers.
14189
14190 @item
14191 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
14192 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
14193 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
14194 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
14195
14196 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
14197 and then we might not encounter the bug.
14198
14199 @item
14200 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
14201 reproduce the bug.
14202
14203 @item
14204 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
14205 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
14206
14207 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
14208 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
14209 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
14210 a chance to make a mistake.
14211
14212 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
14213 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
14214 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
14215 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
14216 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
14217 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
14218 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
14219 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
14220
14221 @item
14222 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
14223 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
14224 it by context, not by line number.
14225
14226 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
14227 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
14228
14229 @end itemize
14230
14231 Here are some things that are not necessary:
14232
14233 @itemize @bullet
14234 @item
14235 A description of the envelope of the bug.
14236
14237 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
14238 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
14239 changes will not affect it.
14240
14241 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
14242 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
14243 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
14244 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
14245
14246 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
14247 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
14248 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
14249 less time, and so on.
14250
14251 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
14252 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
14253
14254 @item
14255 A patch for the bug.
14256
14257 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
14258 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
14259 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
14260 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
14261
14262 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
14263 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
14264 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
14265 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
14266
14267 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
14268 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
14269 help us to understand.
14270
14271 @item
14272 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
14273
14274 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
14275 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
14276 @end itemize
14277
14278 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
14279 @c and consists of the two following files:
14280 @c rluser.texinfo
14281 @c inc-hist.texinfo
14282 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
14283 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
14284 @include rluser.texinfo
14285 @include inc-hist.texinfo
14286
14287
14288 @node Formatting Documentation
14289 @appendix Formatting Documentation
14290
14291 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
14292 @cindex reference card
14293 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
14294 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
14295 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
14296 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
14297 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
14298 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
14299
14300 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
14301 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
14302
14303 @smallexample
14304 make refcard.dvi
14305 @end smallexample
14306
14307 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
14308 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
14309 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
14310 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
14311 your @sc{dvi} output program.
14312
14313 @cindex documentation
14314
14315 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
14316 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
14317 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
14318 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
14319 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
14320 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
14321
14322 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
14323 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
14324 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
14325 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
14326 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
14327 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
14328 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
14329 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
14330
14331 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
14332 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
14333 @code{makeinfo}.
14334
14335 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
14336 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
14337 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
14338
14339 @smallexample
14340 cd gdb
14341 make gdb.info
14342 @end smallexample
14343
14344 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
14345 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
14346 Texinfo definitions file.
14347
14348 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
14349 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
14350 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
14351 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
14352 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
14353 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
14354 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
14355
14356 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
14357 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
14358 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
14359 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
14360 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
14361 directory.
14362
14363 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
14364 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
14365 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
14366 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
14367
14368 @smallexample
14369 make gdb.dvi
14370 @end smallexample
14371
14372 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
14373
14374 @node Installing GDB
14375 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
14376 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
14377 @cindex installation
14378 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}, and source tree subdirectories
14379
14380 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
14381 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
14382 build the @code{gdb} program.
14383 @iftex
14384 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
14385 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
14386 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
14387 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
14388 @end iftex
14389
14390 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
14391 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
14392 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
14393
14394 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
14395 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
14396
14397 @table @code
14398 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
14399 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
14400
14401 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
14402 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
14403
14404 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
14405 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
14406
14407 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
14408 @sc{gnu} include files
14409
14410 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
14411 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
14412
14413 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
14414 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
14415
14416 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
14417 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
14418
14419 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
14420 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
14421
14422 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
14423 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
14424 @end table
14425
14426 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
14427 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
14428 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
14429
14430 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
14431 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
14432 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
14433 argument.
14434
14435 For example:
14436
14437 @smallexample
14438 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14439 ./configure @var{host}
14440 make
14441 @end smallexample
14442
14443 @noindent
14444 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
14445 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
14446 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
14447 correct value by examining your system.)
14448
14449 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
14450 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
14451 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
14452 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
14453
14454 @need 750
14455 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
14456 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
14457 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
14458
14459 @smallexample
14460 sh configure @var{host}
14461 @end smallexample
14462
14463 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
14464 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
14465 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
14466 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
14467 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
14468
14469 You should run the @code{configure} script from the top directory in the
14470 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
14471 @code{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
14472 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
14473 if you run the first @code{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
14474 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
14475 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
14476 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
14477 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
14478
14479 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
14480 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
14481 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
14482 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
14483 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
14484
14485 @menu
14486 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14487 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
14488 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
14489 @end menu
14490
14491 @node Separate Objdir
14492 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
14493
14494 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
14495 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
14496 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
14497 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
14498 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
14499 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
14500 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
14501 program specified there.
14502
14503 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
14504 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
14505 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
14506 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
14507 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
14508 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
14509
14510 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
14511 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
14512
14513 @smallexample
14514 @group
14515 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
14516 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
14517 cd ../gdb-sun4
14518 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
14519 make
14520 @end group
14521 @end smallexample
14522
14523 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
14524 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
14525 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
14526 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
14527 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
14528 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
14529
14530 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
14531 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
14532 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
14533 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
14534 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
14535
14536 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
14537 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
14538 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
14539 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
14540 You specify a cross-debugging target by
14541 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
14542
14543 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
14544 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
14545 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
14546
14547 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
14548 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
14549 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
14550 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
14551 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
14552
14553 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
14554 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
14555 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
14556 with each other.
14557
14558 @node Config Names
14559 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
14560
14561 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
14562 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
14563 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
14564 of information in the following pattern:
14565
14566 @smallexample
14567 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
14568 @end smallexample
14569
14570 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
14571 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
14572 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
14573
14574 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
14575 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
14576 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
14577 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
14578 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
14579 abbreviations---for example:
14580
14581 @smallexample
14582 % sh config.sub i386-linux
14583 i386-pc-linux-gnu
14584 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
14585 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
14586 % sh config.sub hp9k700
14587 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
14588 % sh config.sub sun4
14589 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
14590 % sh config.sub sun3
14591 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
14592 % sh config.sub i986v
14593 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
14594 @end smallexample
14595
14596 @noindent
14597 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
14598 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
14599
14600 @node Configure Options
14601 @section @code{configure} options
14602
14603 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
14604 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
14605 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
14606 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
14607
14608 @smallexample
14609 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
14610 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14611 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
14612 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
14613 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
14614 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
14615 @var{host}
14616 @end smallexample
14617
14618 @noindent
14619 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
14620 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
14621 @samp{--}.
14622
14623 @table @code
14624 @item --help
14625 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
14626
14627 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
14628 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
14629 @file{@var{dir}}.
14630
14631 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
14632 Configure the source to install programs under directory
14633 @file{@var{dir}}.
14634
14635 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
14636 @need 2000
14637 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
14638 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
14639 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
14640 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
14641 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
14642 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
14643 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
14644 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
14645 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
14646 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
14647 @var{dirname}.
14648
14649 @item --norecursion
14650 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
14651 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
14652
14653 @item --target=@var{target}
14654 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
14655 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
14656 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
14657
14658 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
14659
14660 @item @var{host} @dots{}
14661 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
14662
14663 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
14664 @end table
14665
14666 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
14667 needed for special purposes only.
14668
14669 @node Maintenance Commands
14670 @appendix Maintenance Commands
14671 @cindex maintenance commands
14672 @cindex internal commands
14673
14674 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
14675 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
14676 These commands are provided here for reference.
14677
14678 @table @code
14679 @kindex maint info breakpoints
14680 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
14681 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
14682 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
14683 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
14684 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
14685 is shown:
14686
14687 @table @code
14688 @item breakpoint
14689 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
14690
14691 @item watchpoint
14692 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
14693
14694 @item longjmp
14695 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
14696 @code{longjmp} calls.
14697
14698 @item longjmp resume
14699 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
14700
14701 @item until
14702 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
14703
14704 @item finish
14705 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
14706
14707 @item shlib events
14708 Shared library events.
14709
14710 @end table
14711
14712 @kindex maint internal-error
14713 @kindex maint internal-warning
14714 @item maint internal-error
14715 @itemx maint internal-warning
14716 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error}
14717 or @code{internal_warning} and hence behave as though an internal error
14718 or internal warning has been detected. In addition to reporting the
14719 internal problem, these functions give the user the opportunity to
14720 either quit @value{GDBN} or create a core file of the current
14721 @value{GDBN} session.
14722
14723 @smallexample
14724 (gdb) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
14725 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
14726 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
14727 debugging may prove unreliable.
14728 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14729 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
14730 (gdb)
14731 @end smallexample
14732
14733 Takes an optional parameter that is used as the text of the error or
14734 warning message.
14735
14736 @kindex maint print registers
14737 @kindex maint print raw-registers
14738 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
14739 @kindex maint print register-groups
14740 @item maint print registers
14741 @itemx maint print raw-registers
14742 @itemx maint print cooked-registers
14743 @itemx maint print register-groups
14744 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
14745
14746 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
14747 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print cooked-registers}
14748 includes the (cooked) value of all registers; and the command
14749 @code{maint print register-groups} includes the groups that each
14750 register is a member of. @xref{Registers,, Registers, gdbint,
14751 @value{GDBN} Internals}.
14752
14753 Takes an optional file parameter.
14754
14755 @kindex maint print reggroups
14756 @item maint print reggroups
14757 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures.
14758
14759 Takes an optional file parameter.
14760
14761 @smallexample
14762 (gdb) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
14763 Group Type
14764 general user
14765 float user
14766 all user
14767 vector user
14768 system user
14769 save internal
14770 restore internal
14771 @end smallexample
14772
14773 @kindex maint set profile
14774 @kindex maint show profile
14775 @cindex profiling GDB
14776 @item maint set profile
14777 @itemx maint show profile
14778 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
14779
14780 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
14781 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
14782 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
14783 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
14784 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
14785 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
14786 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
14787
14788 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
14789 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
14790
14791 @end table
14792
14793
14794 @node Remote Protocol
14795 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
14796
14797 @menu
14798 * Overview::
14799 * Packets::
14800 * Stop Reply Packets::
14801 * General Query Packets::
14802 * Register Packet Format::
14803 * Examples::
14804 @end menu
14805
14806 @node Overview
14807 @section Overview
14808
14809 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
14810 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
14811 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
14812 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
14813
14814 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
14815 transmitted and received data respectfully.
14816
14817 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14818 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14819 @cindex remote serial protocol
14820 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14821 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14822 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14823 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
14824
14825 @smallexample
14826 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14827 @end smallexample
14828 @noindent
14829
14830 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14831 @noindent
14832 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14833 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14834 eight bit unsigned checksum).
14835
14836 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14837 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
14838
14839 @smallexample
14840 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14841 @end smallexample
14842
14843 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14844 @noindent
14845 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14846 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14847 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
14848
14849 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14850 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14851 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14852 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14853 retransmission):
14854
14855 @smallexample
14856 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14857 <- @code{+}
14858 @end smallexample
14859 @noindent
14860
14861 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14862 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14863 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14864 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
14865
14866 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14867 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14868 exceptions).
14869
14870 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
14871 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
14872 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
14873 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
14874
14875 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14876 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14877 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
14878
14879 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14880 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14881 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14882 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14883 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14884 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14885 value greater than 126 should not be used.
14886
14887 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14888 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14889 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
14890
14891 So:
14892 @smallexample
14893 "@code{0* }"
14894 @end smallexample
14895 @noindent
14896 means the same as "0000".
14897
14898 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14899 error number. That number is not well defined.
14900
14901 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14902 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14903 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14904 on that response.
14905
14906 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14907 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14908 optional.
14909
14910 @node Packets
14911 @section Packets
14912
14913 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
14914 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
14915
14916 @table @r
14917
14918 @item @code{!} --- extended mode
14919 @cindex @code{!} packet
14920
14921 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14922 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14923 debugged.
14924
14925 Reply:
14926 @table @samp
14927 @item OK
14928 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
14929 @end table
14930
14931 @item @code{?} --- last signal
14932 @cindex @code{?} packet
14933
14934 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
14935 step and continue.
14936
14937 Reply:
14938 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14939
14940 @item @code{a} --- reserved
14941
14942 Reserved for future use.
14943
14944 @item @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,@dots{}} --- set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14945 @cindex @code{A} packet
14946
14947 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14948 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
14949 See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
14950
14951 Reply:
14952 @table @samp
14953 @item OK
14954 @item E@var{NN}
14955 @end table
14956
14957 @item @code{b}@var{baud} --- set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14958 @cindex @code{b} packet
14959
14960 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
14961
14962 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
14963 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
14964 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
14965
14966 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
14967 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
14968 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
14969 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
14970 of view, nothing actually happened.}
14971
14972 @item @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode} --- set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14973 @cindex @code{B} packet
14974
14975 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
14976 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
14977
14978 This packet has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets
14979 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
14980
14981 @item @code{c}@var{addr} --- continue
14982 @cindex @code{c} packet
14983
14984 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14985 current address.
14986
14987 Reply:
14988 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14989
14990 @item @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- continue with signal
14991 @cindex @code{C} packet
14992
14993 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14994 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
14995
14996 Reply:
14997 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
14998
14999 @item @code{d} --- toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
15000 @cindex @code{d} packet
15001
15002 Toggle debug flag.
15003
15004 @item @code{D} --- detach
15005 @cindex @code{D} packet
15006
15007 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target
15008 before @value{GDBN} disconnects.
15009
15010 Reply:
15011 @table @samp
15012 @item @emph{no response}
15013 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
15014 @end table
15015
15016 @item @code{e} --- reserved
15017
15018 Reserved for future use.
15019
15020 @item @code{E} --- reserved
15021
15022 Reserved for future use.
15023
15024 @item @code{f} --- reserved
15025
15026 Reserved for future use.
15027
15028 @item @code{F} --- reserved
15029
15030 Reserved for future use.
15031
15032 @item @code{g} --- read registers
15033 @anchor{read registers packet}
15034 @cindex @code{g} packet
15035
15036 Read general registers.
15037
15038 Reply:
15039 @table @samp
15040 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
15041 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
15042 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
15043 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
15044 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}
15045 and @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
15046 @code{g} packets is specified below.
15047 @item E@var{NN}
15048 for an error.
15049 @end table
15050
15051 @item @code{G}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write regs
15052 @cindex @code{G} packet
15053
15054 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of the @var{XX@dots{}}
15055 data.
15056
15057 Reply:
15058 @table @samp
15059 @item OK
15060 for success
15061 @item E@var{NN}
15062 for an error
15063 @end table
15064
15065 @item @code{h} --- reserved
15066
15067 Reserved for future use.
15068
15069 @item @code{H}@var{c}@var{t@dots{}} --- set thread
15070 @cindex @code{H} packet
15071
15072 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
15073 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} depends on the operation to be performed: it
15074 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations, @samp{g} for other
15075 operations. The thread designator @var{t@dots{}} may be -1, meaning all
15076 the threads, a thread number, or zero which means pick any thread.
15077
15078 Reply:
15079 @table @samp
15080 @item OK
15081 for success
15082 @item E@var{NN}
15083 for an error
15084 @end table
15085
15086 @c FIXME: JTC:
15087 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
15088 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
15089 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
15090 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
15091 @c described. For example:
15092 @c
15093 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
15094 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
15095 @c otherwise returns current registers.
15096 @c
15097 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
15098 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
15099 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
15100
15101 @item @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn} --- cycle step @strong{(draft)}
15102 @anchor{cycle step packet}
15103 @cindex @code{i} packet
15104
15105 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
15106 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
15107 step starting at that address.
15108
15109 @item @code{I} --- signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
15110 @cindex @code{I} packet
15111
15112 @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle step packet}.
15113
15114 @item @code{j} --- reserved
15115
15116 Reserved for future use.
15117
15118 @item @code{J} --- reserved
15119
15120 Reserved for future use.
15121
15122 @item @code{k} --- kill request
15123 @cindex @code{k} packet
15124
15125 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
15126 thread context has been selected (i.e.@: does 'k' kill only that
15127 thread?)}.
15128
15129 @item @code{K} --- reserved
15130
15131 Reserved for future use.
15132
15133 @item @code{l} --- reserved
15134
15135 Reserved for future use.
15136
15137 @item @code{L} --- reserved
15138
15139 Reserved for future use.
15140
15141 @item @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- read memory
15142 @cindex @code{m} packet
15143
15144 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
15145 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are
15146 assumed using word aligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
15147 transfer mechanism is needed.}
15148
15149 Reply:
15150 @table @samp
15151 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
15152 @var{XX@dots{}} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
15153 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume
15154 that sized memory transfers are assumed using word aligned
15155 accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is
15156 needed.}
15157 @item E@var{NN}
15158 @var{NN} is errno
15159 @end table
15160
15161 @item @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem
15162 @cindex @code{M} packet
15163
15164 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
15165 @var{XX@dots{}} is the data.
15166
15167 Reply:
15168 @table @samp
15169 @item OK
15170 for success
15171 @item E@var{NN}
15172 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
15173 written).
15174 @end table
15175
15176 @item @code{n} --- reserved
15177
15178 Reserved for future use.
15179
15180 @item @code{N} --- reserved
15181
15182 Reserved for future use.
15183
15184 @item @code{o} --- reserved
15185
15186 Reserved for future use.
15187
15188 @item @code{O} --- reserved
15189
15190 Reserved for future use.
15191
15192 @item @code{p}@var{n@dots{}} --- read reg @strong{(reserved)}
15193 @cindex @code{p} packet
15194
15195 @xref{write register packet}.
15196
15197 Reply:
15198 @table @samp
15199 @item @var{r@dots{}.}
15200 The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
15201 @end table
15202
15203 @item @code{P}@var{n@dots{}}@code{=}@var{r@dots{}} --- write register
15204 @anchor{write register packet}
15205 @cindex @code{P} packet
15206
15207 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}, which contains two hex
15208 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
15209
15210 Reply:
15211 @table @samp
15212 @item OK
15213 for success
15214 @item E@var{NN}
15215 for an error
15216 @end table
15217
15218 @item @code{q}@var{query} --- general query
15219 @anchor{general query packet}
15220 @cindex @code{q} packet
15221
15222 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries have a
15223 leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a company
15224 prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may optionally
15225 be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs must ensure
15226 that they match the full @var{query} name.
15227
15228 Reply:
15229 @table @samp
15230 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
15231 Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
15232 @item E@var{NN}
15233 error reply
15234 @item
15235 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
15236 @end table
15237
15238 @item @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val} --- general set
15239 @cindex @code{Q} packet
15240
15241 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}.
15242
15243 @xref{general query packet}, for a discussion of naming conventions.
15244
15245 @item @code{r} --- reset @strong{(deprecated)}
15246 @cindex @code{r} packet
15247
15248 Reset the entire system.
15249
15250 @item @code{R}@var{XX} --- remote restart
15251 @cindex @code{R} packet
15252
15253 Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
15254 This packet is only available in extended mode.
15255
15256 Reply:
15257 @table @samp
15258 @item @emph{no reply}
15259 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
15260 @end table
15261
15262 @item @code{s}@var{addr} --- step
15263 @cindex @code{s} packet
15264
15265 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
15266 same address.
15267
15268 Reply:
15269 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15270
15271 @item @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr} --- step with signal
15272 @anchor{step with signal packet}
15273 @cindex @code{S} packet
15274
15275 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
15276
15277 Reply:
15278 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
15279
15280 @item @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM} --- search
15281 @cindex @code{t} packet
15282
15283 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
15284 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4 bytes.
15285 @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
15286
15287 @item @code{T}@var{XX} --- thread alive
15288 @cindex @code{T} packet
15289
15290 Find out if the thread XX is alive.
15291
15292 Reply:
15293 @table @samp
15294 @item OK
15295 thread is still alive
15296 @item E@var{NN}
15297 thread is dead
15298 @end table
15299
15300 @item @code{u} --- reserved
15301
15302 Reserved for future use.
15303
15304 @item @code{U} --- reserved
15305
15306 Reserved for future use.
15307
15308 @item @code{v} --- reserved
15309
15310 Reserved for future use.
15311
15312 @item @code{V} --- reserved
15313
15314 Reserved for future use.
15315
15316 @item @code{w} --- reserved
15317
15318 Reserved for future use.
15319
15320 @item @code{W} --- reserved
15321
15322 Reserved for future use.
15323
15324 @item @code{x} --- reserved
15325
15326 Reserved for future use.
15327
15328 @item @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX@dots{}} --- write mem (binary)
15329 @cindex @code{X} packet
15330
15331 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX@dots{}}
15332 is binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
15333 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
15334
15335 Reply:
15336 @table @samp
15337 @item OK
15338 for success
15339 @item E@var{NN}
15340 for an error
15341 @end table
15342
15343 @item @code{y} --- reserved
15344
15345 Reserved for future use.
15346
15347 @item @code{Y} reserved
15348
15349 Reserved for future use.
15350
15351 @item @code{z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15352 @itemx @code{Z}@var{type}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert breakpoint or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15353 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
15354 @cindex @code{z} packet
15355 @cindex @code{Z} packets
15356
15357 Insert (@code{Z}) or remove (@code{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
15358 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} and covering the next
15359 @var{length} bytes.
15360
15361 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
15362 separately.
15363
15364 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
15365 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
15366 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
15367 @code{Z}@var{type}@dots{} and @code{z}@var{type}@dots{} packet pair. To
15368 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
15369 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
15370
15371 @item @code{z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15372 @item @code{Z}@code{0}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert memory breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15373 @cindex @code{z0} packet
15374 @cindex @code{Z0} packet
15375
15376 Insert (@code{Z0}) or remove (@code{z0}) a memory breakpoint at address
15377 @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15378
15379 A memory breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
15380 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
15381 @code{length} is used by targets that indicates the size of the
15382 breakpoint (in bytes) that should be inserted (e.g., the @sc{arm} and
15383 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint).
15384
15385 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
15386 code that contains memory breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
15387 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
15388 target, is not defined.}
15389
15390 Reply:
15391 @table @samp
15392 @item OK
15393 success
15394 @item
15395 not supported
15396 @item E@var{NN}
15397 for an error
15398 @end table
15399
15400 @item @code{z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15401 @item @code{Z}@code{1}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert hardware breakpoint @strong{(draft)}
15402 @cindex @code{z1} packet
15403 @cindex @code{Z1} packet
15404
15405 Insert (@code{Z1}) or remove (@code{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
15406 address @code{addr} of size @code{length}.
15407
15408 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
15409 dependant on being able to modify the target's memory.
15410
15411 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
15412 movement.}
15413
15414 Reply:
15415 @table @samp
15416 @item OK
15417 success
15418 @item
15419 not supported
15420 @item E@var{NN}
15421 for an error
15422 @end table
15423
15424 @item @code{z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15425 @item @code{Z}@code{2}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert write watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15426 @cindex @code{z2} packet
15427 @cindex @code{Z2} packet
15428
15429 Insert (@code{Z2}) or remove (@code{z2}) a write watchpoint.
15430
15431 Reply:
15432 @table @samp
15433 @item OK
15434 success
15435 @item
15436 not supported
15437 @item E@var{NN}
15438 for an error
15439 @end table
15440
15441 @item @code{z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15442 @item @code{Z}@code{3}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert read watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15443 @cindex @code{z3} packet
15444 @cindex @code{Z3} packet
15445
15446 Insert (@code{Z3}) or remove (@code{z3}) a read watchpoint.
15447
15448 Reply:
15449 @table @samp
15450 @item OK
15451 success
15452 @item
15453 not supported
15454 @item E@var{NN}
15455 for an error
15456 @end table
15457
15458 @item @code{z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- remove access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15459 @item @code{Z}@code{4}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- insert access watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
15460 @cindex @code{z4} packet
15461 @cindex @code{Z4} packet
15462
15463 Insert (@code{Z4}) or remove (@code{z4}) an access watchpoint.
15464
15465 Reply:
15466 @table @samp
15467 @item OK
15468 success
15469 @item
15470 not supported
15471 @item E@var{NN}
15472 for an error
15473 @end table
15474
15475 @end table
15476
15477 @node Stop Reply Packets
15478 @section Stop Reply Packets
15479 @cindex stop reply packets
15480
15481 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
15482 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
15483 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
15484 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
15485 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
15486 conventions is used.
15487
15488 @table @samp
15489
15490 @item S@var{AA}
15491 @var{AA} is the signal number
15492
15493 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
15494 @cindex @code{T} packet reply
15495
15496 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
15497 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
15498 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
15499 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = (@samp{watch} |
15500 @samp{rwatch} | @samp{awatch}, @var{r...} = data address, this is a hex
15501 integer; @var{n...} = other string not starting with valid hex digit.
15502 @value{GDBN} should ignore this @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on
15503 to the next. This way we can extend the protocol.
15504
15505 @item W@var{AA}
15506
15507 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
15508 applicable to certain targets.
15509
15510 @item X@var{AA}
15511
15512 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
15513
15514 @item N@var{AA};@var{t@dots{}};@var{d@dots{}};@var{b@dots{}} @strong{(obsolete)}
15515
15516 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t@dots{}} = address of symbol
15517 @code{_start}; @var{d@dots{}} = base of data section; @var{b@dots{}} =
15518 base of bss section. @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets.
15519 The difference between this reply and the @samp{qOffsets} query is that
15520 the @samp{N} packet may arrive spontaneously whereas the @samp{qOffsets}
15521 is a query initiated by the host debugger.}
15522
15523 @item O@var{XX@dots{}}
15524
15525 @var{XX@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at
15526 any time while the program is running and the debugger should continue
15527 to wait for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc.
15528
15529 @end table
15530
15531 @node General Query Packets
15532 @section General Query Packets
15533
15534 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
15535
15536 @table @r
15537
15538 @item @code{q}@code{C} --- current thread
15539
15540 Return the current thread id.
15541
15542 Reply:
15543 @table @samp
15544 @item @code{QC}@var{pid}
15545 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
15546 @item *
15547 Any other reply implies the old pid.
15548 @end table
15549
15550 @item @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} -- all thread ids
15551
15552 @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
15553
15554 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
15555 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
15556 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
15557 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
15558 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
15559 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
15560
15561 NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
15562
15563 Reply:
15564 @table @samp
15565 @item @code{m}@var{id}
15566 A single thread id
15567 @item @code{m}@var{id},@var{id}@dots{}
15568 a comma-separated list of thread ids
15569 @item @code{l}
15570 (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
15571 @end table
15572
15573 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
15574 more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. @value{GDBN}
15575 will respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
15576 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
15577 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
15578
15579 @item @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id} --- extra thread info
15580
15581 Where @var{id} is a thread-id in big-endian hex. Obtain a printable
15582 string description of a thread's attributes from the target OS. This
15583 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting for
15584 @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is displayed
15585 in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display. Some examples of
15586 possible thread extra info strings are ``Runnable'', or ``Blocked on
15587 Mutex''.
15588
15589 Reply:
15590 @table @samp
15591 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
15592 Where @var{XX@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising
15593 the printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
15594 attributes.
15595 @end table
15596
15597 @item @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread} --- query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
15598
15599 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
15600 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
15601 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
15602 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
15603 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
15604 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
15605
15606 NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo} query
15607 (see above).
15608
15609 Reply:
15610 @table @samp
15611 @item @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread@dots{}}
15612 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
15613 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
15614 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
15615 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread@dots{}}
15616 is a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
15617 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
15618 @end table
15619
15620 @item @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length} --- compute CRC of memory block
15621
15622 Reply:
15623 @table @samp
15624 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
15625 An error (such as memory fault)
15626 @item @code{C}@var{CRC32}
15627 A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
15628 @end table
15629
15630 @item @code{q}@code{Offsets} --- query sect offs
15631
15632 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
15633 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
15634 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
15635 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
15636
15637 Reply:
15638 @table @samp
15639 @item @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
15640 @end table
15641
15642 @item @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid} --- thread info request
15643
15644 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
15645 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
15646
15647 Reply:
15648 @table @samp
15649 @item *
15650 @end table
15651
15652 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
15653
15654 @item @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{command} --- remote command
15655
15656 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
15657 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
15658 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
15659 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{output} console output packets.
15660 @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a stubs's
15661 interpreter may have security implications}.
15662
15663 Reply:
15664 @table @samp
15665 @item OK
15666 A command response with no output.
15667 @item @var{OUTPUT}
15668 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
15669 @item @code{E}@var{NN}
15670 Indicate a badly formed request.
15671 @item @samp{}
15672 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
15673 @end table
15674
15675 @item @code{qSymbol::} --- symbol lookup
15676
15677 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
15678 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
15679
15680 Reply:
15681 @table @samp
15682 @item @code{OK}
15683 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
15684 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15685 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
15686 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
15687 @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} message, described below.
15688 @end table
15689
15690 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name} --- symbol value
15691
15692 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
15693
15694 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
15695 target has previously requested.
15696
15697 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
15698 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
15699 will be empty.
15700
15701 Reply:
15702 @table @samp
15703 @item @code{OK}
15704 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
15705 @item @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
15706 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
15707 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
15708 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
15709 @end table
15710
15711 @end table
15712
15713 @node Register Packet Format
15714 @section Register Packet Format
15715
15716 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
15717 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
15718 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
15719 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target
15720 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered
15721 most-significant - least-significant.
15722
15723 @table @r
15724
15725 @item MIPS32
15726
15727 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
15728 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
15729 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
15730
15731 @item MIPS64
15732
15733 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
15734 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
15735 as @code{MIPS32}.
15736
15737 @end table
15738
15739 @node Examples
15740 @section Examples
15741
15742 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
15743 does not get any direct output:
15744
15745 @smallexample
15746 -> @code{R00}
15747 <- @code{+}
15748 @emph{target restarts}
15749 -> @code{?}
15750 <- @code{+}
15751 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15752 -> @code{+}
15753 @end smallexample
15754
15755 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
15756
15757 @smallexample
15758 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
15759 <- @code{+}
15760 -> @code{s}
15761 <- @code{+}
15762 @emph{time passes}
15763 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
15764 -> @code{+}
15765 -> @code{g}
15766 <- @code{+}
15767 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
15768 -> @code{+}
15769 @end smallexample
15770
15771 @include gpl.texi
15772
15773 @include fdl.texi
15774
15775 @node Index
15776 @unnumbered Index
15777
15778 @printindex cp
15779
15780 @tex
15781 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
15782 % meantime:
15783 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
15784 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
15785 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
15786 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
15787 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
15788 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
15789 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
15790 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
15791 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
15792 \page\colophon
15793 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
15794 @end tex
15795
15796 @bye
This page took 0.397204 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.